blob: bb1b31e3ceabbba619d4570af94187424a735f19 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000043#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
44#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000046#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000047#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000048#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000049#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000050#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000051#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000053#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000058#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000059#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000060using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000061using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000062
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000063STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
64STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
65STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000068
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000069namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000070 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
71 : public FunctionPass,
72 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000073 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000074 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
75 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000076 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000077 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000079 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000080 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
81
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000082 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
83 /// isn't already in it.
84 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
85 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
86 Worklist.push_back(I);
87 }
88
89 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
90 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
91 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
92 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
93
94 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
95 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
96
97 WorklistMap.erase(It);
98 }
99
100 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
101 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
102 Worklist.pop_back();
103 WorklistMap.erase(I);
104 return I;
105 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000106
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000107
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000108 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
109 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
110 /// now.
111 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000112 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000113 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000114 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000115 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000116 }
117
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000118 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
119 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
120 ///
121 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
122 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
123 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000124 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000125 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000126
127 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
128 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
129 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
130 ///
131 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
132 ///
133 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
134 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
135
136 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
137 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000138 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000139 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
140 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
141 }
142
143 return R;
144 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000145
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000146 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000147 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000148
149 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000150
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000151 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000152 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000153 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000154 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000155 }
156
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000157 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
158
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000159 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
160 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
161 // Return Value:
162 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000163 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000164 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000165 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000166 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
167 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000169 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000174 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
175 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
176 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000179 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000182 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
183 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000186 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
187 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
188 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000189 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
190 Instruction *LHS,
191 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000192 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
193 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000194
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000195 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
196 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000197 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000198 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000199 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
200 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000201 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000202 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
203 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
211 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
212 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000213 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000214 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
215 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000216 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000217 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
218 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000219 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
220 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000221 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000222 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000223 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000224 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000225 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000226 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000227 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000228 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000229 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000230
231 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000232 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000233
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000234 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000235 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000236 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
237
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000238 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000239 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
240 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
241 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000242 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000243 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
244 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000245 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
246 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000247 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000248 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000249 }
250
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000251 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
252 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
253 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000254 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
255 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000256 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000257
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000258 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000259 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000260
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000261 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000262 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000263 return C;
264 }
265
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000266 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
267 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
268 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
269 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
270 // modified.
271 //
272 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000273 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000274 if (&I != V) {
275 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
276 return &I;
277 } else {
278 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
279 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000280 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000281 return &I;
282 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000283 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000284
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000285 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
286 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
287 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
288 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
289 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
290 //
291 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
292 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
293 if (Old != New)
294 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
295 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000296 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000297 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000298 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000299 return true;
300 }
301
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000302 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
303 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
304 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
305 // this function.
306 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
307 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
308 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000309 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000310 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000311 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
312 }
313
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000314 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000315 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
316 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
317 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
318 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000319 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
320 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000321 Instruction *InsertBefore);
322
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000323 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
324 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000325 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000326
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000327 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
328 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
329 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
330
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000331 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
332 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000333 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
334 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
335 unsigned Depth = 0);
336
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000337 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
338 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
339
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000340 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
341 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
342 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
343 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
344
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000345 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
346 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
347 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
348 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000349 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
350
351
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000352 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
353 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000354
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000355 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000356 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000357 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000358 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000359 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000360 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000361 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000362
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000363 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000364 };
Chris Lattnerf6293092002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000365
Devang Patel19974732007-05-03 01:11:54 +0000366 char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
Chris Lattner7f8897f2006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000367 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000368}
369
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000370// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000371// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000372static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
373 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
374 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000375 return 3;
376 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000377 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000378 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
379 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000380}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000381
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000382// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
383// it.
384static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000385 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000386}
387
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000388// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
389// though a va_arg area...
390static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000391 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
392 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
393 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000394 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000395 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000396}
397
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000398/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
399/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
400static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
401 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000402 return I->getOperand(0);
403 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000404 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000405 return CE->getOperand(0);
406 return 0;
407}
408
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000409/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
410/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000411static Instruction::CastOps
412isEliminableCastPair(
413 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
414 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
415 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
416 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
417) {
418
419 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
420 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000421
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000422 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
423 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
424 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000425
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000426 return Instruction::CastOps(
427 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
428 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000429}
430
431/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
432/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
433/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000434static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
435 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000436 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
437
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000438 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000439 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000440 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000441 return false;
442 return true;
443}
444
445/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
446/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
447/// casts that are known to not do anything...
448///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000449Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
450 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000451 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
452 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
453 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000454 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000455
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000456 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000457}
458
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000459// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
460// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000461//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000462// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
463// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
464// binary operators.
465//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000466// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
467// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000468//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000469bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000470 bool Changed = false;
471 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
472 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000473
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000474 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
475 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000476 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
477 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
478 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000479 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
480 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
481 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000482 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
483 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
484 return true;
485 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
486 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
487 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
488 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
489 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
490
491 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000492 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000493 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
494 Op1->getOperand(0),
495 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000496 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000497 I.setOperand(0, New);
498 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
499 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000500 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000501 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000502 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000503}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000504
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000505/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
506/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
507/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
508bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
509 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
510 return false;
511 I.swapOperands();
512 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
513 return true;
514}
515
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000516// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
517// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000518//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000519static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
520 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000521 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000522
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000523 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
524 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
525 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000526 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000527}
528
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000529static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
530 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000531 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000532
533 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000534 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000535 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000536 return 0;
537}
538
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000539// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
540// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000541// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
542// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000543//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000544static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000545 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000546 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000547 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000548 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000549 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000550 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000551 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000552 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000553 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000554 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000555 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000556 return I->getOperand(0);
557 }
558 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000559 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000560}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000561
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000562/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
563/// expression, return it.
564static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
565 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
566 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
567 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
568 return cast<User>(V);
569 return false;
570}
571
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000572/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000573static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000574 APInt Val(C->getValue());
575 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000576}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000577/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000578static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000579 APInt Val(C->getValue());
580 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000581}
582/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
583static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
584 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
585}
586/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
587static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
588 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
589}
590/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
591static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
592 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
593}
594/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
595static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
596 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000597}
598
Chris Lattner68d5ff22006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000599/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
600/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000601/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
602/// processing.
603/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
604/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
605/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
606/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
607/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
608/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000609static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000610 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000611 assert(V && "No Value?");
612 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000613 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000614 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000615 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000616 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000617 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000618 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
619 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000620 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000621 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
622 return;
623 }
624
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000625 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
626 return; // Limit search depth.
627
628 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
629 if (!I) return;
630
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000631 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000632 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000633
634 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000635 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000636 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
637 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000638 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
639 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000640 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
641 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
642
643 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
644 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
645 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
646 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
647 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000648 }
649 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000650 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000651 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
652 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000653 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
654 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
655
656 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
657 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
658 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
659 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
660 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000661 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000662 case Instruction::Xor: {
663 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
664 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
665 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
666 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
667
668 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
669 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
670 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
671 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
672 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
673 return;
674 }
675 case Instruction::Select:
676 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
677 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
678 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
679 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
680
681 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
682 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
683 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
684 return;
685 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
686 case Instruction::FPExt:
687 case Instruction::FPToUI:
688 case Instruction::FPToSI:
689 case Instruction::SIToFP:
690 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
691 case Instruction::UIToFP:
692 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
693 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000694 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000695 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000696 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
697 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000698 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
699 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
700 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
701 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
702 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000703 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
704 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000705 return;
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000706 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000707 case Instruction::BitCast: {
708 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
709 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
710 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
711 return;
712 }
713 break;
714 }
715 case Instruction::ZExt: {
716 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
717 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000718 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000719
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000720 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
721 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
722 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
723 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
724 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000725 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
726 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000727 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
728 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000729 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000730 return;
731 }
732 case Instruction::SExt: {
733 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
734 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000735 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000736
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000737 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
738 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
739 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
740 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
741 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000742 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000743 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
744 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000745
746 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
747 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000748 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000749 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000750 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000751 KnownOne |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000752 return;
753 }
754 case Instruction::Shl:
755 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
756 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000757 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000758 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
759 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000760 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng430f6262007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000761 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
762 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000763 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000764 return;
765 }
766 break;
767 case Instruction::LShr:
768 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
769 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
770 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000771 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000772
773 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000774 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
775 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000776 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
777 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
778 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000779 // high bits known zero.
780 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000781 return;
782 }
783 break;
784 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000785 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000786 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
787 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000788 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000789
790 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000791 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
792 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000793 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
794 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
795 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
796
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000797 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
798 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000799 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000800 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000801 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000802 return;
803 }
804 break;
805 }
806}
807
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000808/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
809/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
810/// for bits that V cannot have.
811static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengedd089c2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000812 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000813 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
814 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
815 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
816}
817
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000818/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
819/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
820/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
821/// constant and return true.
822static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000823 APInt Demanded) {
824 assert(I && "No instruction?");
825 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
826
827 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
828 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
829 if (!OpC) return false;
830
831 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
832 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
833 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
834 return false;
835
836 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
837 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
838 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
839 return true;
840}
841
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000842// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
843// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
844// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
845// min/max.
846static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000847 const APInt& KnownZero,
848 const APInt& KnownOne,
849 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
850 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
851 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
852 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
853 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
854 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000855 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000856
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000857 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
858 // bit if it is unknown.
859 Min = KnownOne;
860 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
861
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000862 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000863 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
864 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000865 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000866}
867
868// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
869// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
870// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
871// min/max.
872static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000873 const APInt& KnownZero,
874 const APInt& KnownOne,
875 APInt& Min,
876 APInt& Max) {
877 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
878 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
879 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
880 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
881 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000882 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000883
884 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
885 Min = KnownOne;
886 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
887 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
888}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000889
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000890/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
891/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
892/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
893/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
894/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
895/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
896/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
897/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
898/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
899/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
900/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
901/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
902/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
903/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
904/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
905bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
906 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
907 unsigned Depth) {
908 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
909 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
910 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
911 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
912 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
913 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
914 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
915 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
916 must have same BitWidth");
917 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
918 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
919 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
920 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
921 return false;
922 }
923
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000924 KnownZero.clear();
925 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000926 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
927 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
928 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
929 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
930 return false;
931 }
932 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
933 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
934 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
935 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
936 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
937 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
938 return false;
939 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
940 return false;
941 }
942
943 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
944 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
945
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000946 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
947 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
948 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
949 default: break;
950 case Instruction::And:
951 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
952 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
953 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
954 return true;
955 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
956 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
957
958 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
959 // LHS.
960 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
961 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
962 return true;
963 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
964 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
965
966 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
967 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
968 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
969 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
970 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
971 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
972 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
973 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
974
975 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
976 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
977 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
978
979 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
980 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
981 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
982
983 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
984 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
985 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
986 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
987 break;
988 case Instruction::Or:
989 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
990 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
991 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
992 return true;
993 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
994 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
995 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
996 // LHS.
997 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
998 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
999 return true;
1000 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1001 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1002
1003 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1004 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
1005 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
1006 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
1007 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1008 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1009 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1010 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1011
1012 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1013 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1014 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1015 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1016 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1017 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1018 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1019 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1020
1021 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1022 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1023 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1024
1025 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1026 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1027 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1028 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1029 break;
1030 case Instruction::Xor: {
1031 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1032 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1033 return true;
1034 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1035 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1036 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1037 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1038 return true;
1039 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1040 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1041
1042 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1043 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1044 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1045 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1046 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1047 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1048
1049 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1050 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1051 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1052 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1053 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1054 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1055
1056 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1057 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1058 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1059 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1060 Instruction *Or =
1061 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1062 I->getName());
1063 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1064 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1065 }
1066
1067 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1068 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1069 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1070 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1071 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1072 // all known
1073 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1074 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1075 Instruction *And =
1076 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1077 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1078 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1079 }
1080 }
1081
1082 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1083 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1084 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1085 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1086
1087 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1088 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1089 break;
1090 }
1091 case Instruction::Select:
1092 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1093 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1094 return true;
1095 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1096 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1097 return true;
1098 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1099 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1100 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1101 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1102
1103 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1104 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1105 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1106 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1107 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1108
1109 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1110 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1111 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1112 break;
1113 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1114 uint32_t truncBf =
1115 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001116 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1117 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1118 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1119 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1120 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001121 return true;
1122 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1123 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1124 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1125 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1126 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1127 break;
1128 }
1129 case Instruction::BitCast:
1130 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1131 return false;
1132
1133 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1134 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1135 return true;
1136 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1137 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1138 break;
1139 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1140 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1141 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001142 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001143
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001144 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1145 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1146 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001147 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1148 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 return true;
1150 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1151 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1152 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1153 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1154 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1155 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001156 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001157 break;
1158 }
1159 case Instruction::SExt: {
1160 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1161 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001162 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001163
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001167 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001168 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1169 // bit is demanded.
1170 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001171 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001172
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001173 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1174 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1175 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001176 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1177 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001178 return true;
1179 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1180 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1181 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1182 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1183 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1184
1185 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1186 // top bits of the result.
1187
1188 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1189 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001190 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001191 {
1192 // Convert to ZExt cast
1193 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1194 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001195 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001196 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001197 }
1198 break;
1199 }
1200 case Instruction::Add: {
1201 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1202 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1203 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001204 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205
1206 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1207 // we can do.
1208 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1209 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1210 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1211 if (RHS->isZero())
1212 break;
1213
1214 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1215 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001216 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217
1218 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1219 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1220 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1221 return true;
1222
1223 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1224 // the constant.
1225 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1226 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1227
1228 // Avoid excess work.
1229 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1230 break;
1231
1232 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1233 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1234 Instruction *Or =
1235 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1236 I->getName());
1237 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1238 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1239 }
1240
1241 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1242 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1243 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1244 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1245 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1246
1247 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1248 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1249 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001250 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1251 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001252
1253 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1254
1255 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1256 // other, and there is no input carry.
1257 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1258 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1259
1260 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1261 // is no input carry.
1262 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1263 } else {
1264 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1265 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001266 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1268 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001269 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001270 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1271 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1272 return true;
1273 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1274 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1275 return true;
1276 }
1277 }
1278 break;
1279 }
1280 case Instruction::Sub:
1281 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1282 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001283 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001284 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1285 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001286 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001287 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001288 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1289 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1290 return true;
1291 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1292 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1293 return true;
1294 }
1295 break;
1296 case Instruction::Shl:
1297 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001298 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001299 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001301 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1304 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1305 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1306 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1307 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001308 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001309 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001310 }
1311 break;
1312 case Instruction::LShr:
1313 // For a logical shift right
1314 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001315 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001316
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001317 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001318 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1319 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001320 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1321 return true;
1322 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1323 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001324 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1325 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001326 if (ShiftAmt) {
1327 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001328 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001329 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1330 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001331 }
1332 break;
1333 case Instruction::AShr:
1334 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1335 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1336 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1337 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1338 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1339 // Perform the logical shift right.
1340 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1341 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1342 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1343 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1344 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001345
1346 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1347 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1348 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1349 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001350
1351 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001352 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001353
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001354 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001355 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001356 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1357 // demanded.
1358 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1359 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001360 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001361 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001362 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1363 return true;
1364 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1365 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1366 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001367 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001368 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1369 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1370
1371 // Handle the sign bits.
1372 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1373 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1374 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1375
1376 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1377 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001378 if (RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001379 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1380 // Perform the logical shift right.
1381 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1382 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1383 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1384 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1385 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1386 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1387 }
1388 }
1389 break;
1390 }
1391
1392 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1393 // constant.
1394 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1395 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1396 return false;
1397}
1398
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001399
1400/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1401/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1402/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1403/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1404///
1405/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1406/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1407/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1408Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1409 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1410 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001412 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1413 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1414 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1415 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1416
1417 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1418 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1419 UndefElts = EltMask;
1420 return 0;
1421 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1422 UndefElts = EltMask;
1423 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1424 }
1425
1426 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001427 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1428 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001429 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1430
1431 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1432 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1433 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1434 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1435 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1436 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1437 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1438 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1439 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1440 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1441 }
1442
1443 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001444 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001445 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1446 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001447 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001448 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001449 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001450 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1451 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1452 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1453 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1454 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1455 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001456 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001457 }
1458
1459 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1460 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1461 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1462 return false;
1463 }
1464 return false;
1465 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1466 return false;
1467 }
1468
1469 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1470 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1471
1472 bool MadeChange = false;
1473 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1474 Value *TmpV;
1475 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1476 default: break;
1477
1478 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1479 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1480 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001481 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001482 if (Idx == 0) {
1483 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1484 // which elt is getting updated.
1485 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1486 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1487 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1488 break;
1489 }
1490
1491 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1492 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001493 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001494 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1495 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1496
1497 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1498 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1499 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1500 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1501 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1502 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1503
1504 // The inserted element is defined.
1505 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1506 break;
1507 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001508 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001509 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001510 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1511 if (!VTy) break;
1512 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1513 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1514 unsigned Ratio;
1515
1516 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001517 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001518 // elements as are demanded of us.
1519 Ratio = 1;
1520 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1521 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1522 // Untested so far.
1523 break;
1524
1525 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1526 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1527 // elements are live.
1528 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1529 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1530 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1531 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1532 }
1533 } else {
1534 // Untested so far.
1535 break;
1536
1537 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1538 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1539 // live.
1540 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1541 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1542 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1543 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1544 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001545
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001546 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1547 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1548 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1549 if (TmpV) {
1550 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1551 MadeChange = true;
1552 }
1553
1554 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1555 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1556 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1557 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1558 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1559 // undef.
1560 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1561 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1562 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1563 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1564 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1565 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1566 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1567 // elements are undef.
1568 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1569 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1570 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1571 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1572 }
1573 break;
1574 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001575 case Instruction::And:
1576 case Instruction::Or:
1577 case Instruction::Xor:
1578 case Instruction::Add:
1579 case Instruction::Sub:
1580 case Instruction::Mul:
1581 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1582 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1583 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1584 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1585 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1586 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1587 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1588
1589 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1590 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1591 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1592 break;
1593
1594 case Instruction::Call: {
1595 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1596 if (!II) break;
1597 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1598 default: break;
1599
1600 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1601 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1602 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1603 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1604 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1605 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1606 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1607 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1608 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1609 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1610 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1611 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1612 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1613 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1614 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1615 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1616
1617 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1618 // scalarize it now.
1619 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1620 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1621 default: break;
1622 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1623 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1624 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1625 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1626 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1627 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1628 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1629 // Extract the element as scalars.
1630 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1631 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1632
1633 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1634 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1635 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1637 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1638 II->getName()), *II);
1639 break;
1640 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1642 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1643 II->getName()), *II);
1644 break;
1645 }
1646
1647 Instruction *New =
1648 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1649 II->getName());
1650 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1651 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1652 return New;
1653 }
1654 }
1655
1656 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1657 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1658 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1659 break;
1660 }
1661 break;
1662 }
1663 }
1664 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1665}
1666
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001667/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1668/// true when both operands are equal...
1669/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true if both operands are equal
1670static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1671 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = ICI.getPredicate();
1672 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1673 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1674 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1675}
1676
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001677/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1678/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1679/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1680/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1681/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1682/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1683/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1684///
1685template<typename Functor>
1686Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1687 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1688 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1689
1690 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1691 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1692 return F.apply(Root);
1693
1694 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1695 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001696 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001697 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1698 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1699
1700 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1701 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1702 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1703 ShouldApply = true;
1704 }
1705
1706 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1707 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1708 if (ShouldApply) {
1709 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001710
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001711 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1712 // and perform the reassociation.
1713 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1714
1715 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1716 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1717
1718 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1719 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001720 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001721 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1722 return 0;
1723 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001724 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001725 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001726 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1727 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1728 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1729 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001730
1731 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1732 // get to LHSI.
1733 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1734 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001735 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1736 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1737 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1738 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1739 ARI = NextLHSI;
1740
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001741 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1742 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1743 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1744 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1745 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001746
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001747 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1748 // the transformation...
1749 return F.apply(Root);
1750 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001751
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001752 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1753 }
1754 return 0;
1755}
1756
1757
1758// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1759struct AddRHS {
1760 Value *RHS;
1761 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1762 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1763 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001764 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001765 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001766 }
1767};
1768
1769// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1770// iff C1&C2 == 0
1771struct AddMaskingAnd {
1772 Constant *C2;
1773 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1774 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001775 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001776 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001777 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001778 }
1779 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001780 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001781 }
1782};
1783
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001784static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001785 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001786 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001787 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001788 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001789
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001790 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1791 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001792 }
1793
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001794 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001795 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1796 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001797
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001798 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1799 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001800 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1801 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001802 }
1803
1804 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1805 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1806 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1807 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001808 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1809 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001810 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1811 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1812 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001813 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001814 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001815 abort();
1816 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001817 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1818}
1819
1820// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1821// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1822// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1823// not have a second operand.
1824static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1825 InstCombiner *IC) {
1826 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1827 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1828 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1829 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1830
1831 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001832 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001833 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001834
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001835 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1836 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1837
1838 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1839 SelectFalseVal);
1840 }
1841 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001842}
1843
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001844
1845/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1846/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1847/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1848Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1849 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001850 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001851 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001852
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001853 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1854 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001855 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001856 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1857 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1858 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1859 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001860 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001861 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1862
1863 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1864 // loop.
1865 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1866 return 0;
1867 }
1868
1869 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1870 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1871 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1872 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1873 if (NonConstBB) {
1874 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1875 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1876 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001877
1878 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001879 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001880 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001881 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001882 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001883
1884 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1885 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1886 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001887 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001888 Value *InV;
1889 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001890 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1891 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1892 else
1893 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001894 } else {
1895 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1896 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1897 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1898 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1899 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001900 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1901 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1902 CI->getPredicate(),
1903 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1904 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001905 else
1906 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1907
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001908 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001909 }
1910 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001911 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001912 } else {
1913 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1914 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001915 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001916 Value *InV;
1917 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001918 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001919 } else {
1920 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001921 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1922 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1923 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001924 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001925 }
1926 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001927 }
1928 }
1929 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1930}
1931
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001932Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001933 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001934 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001935
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001936 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001937 // X + undef -> undef
1938 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1940
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001941 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001942 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001943 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001945 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
1946 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(-0.0))
1947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001948 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001949
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001950 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001951 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001952 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001953 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001954 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001955 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001956
1957 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1958 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001959 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1960 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1961 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1962 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1963 return &I;
1964 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001965 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001966
1967 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1968 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1969 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001970
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001971 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1972 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001973 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1974 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001975 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001976 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001977
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001978 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001979 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1980 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001981 do {
1982 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001983 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1984 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001985 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1986 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001987 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001988 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1989 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001990 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001991 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001992 }
1993 }
1994 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001995 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1996 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1997 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001998
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001999 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
2000 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
2001 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
2002 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
2003 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2004 switch (Size) {
2005 default: break;
2006 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2007 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2008 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2009 }
2010 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002011 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002012 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002013 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002014 }
2015 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002016 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002017
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002018 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002019 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002020 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002021
2022 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2023 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2024 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2025 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2026 }
2027 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2028 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2029 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2031 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002032 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002033
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002034 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002035 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002036 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002037
2038 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002039 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2040 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002041 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002042
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002043
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002044 ConstantInt *C2;
2045 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2046 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
2047 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
2048
2049 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2050 ConstantInt *C1;
2051 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002052 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002053 }
2054
2055 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002056 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2057 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
2058
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002059 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002060 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002062
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002063
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002064 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002065 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002066 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2067 return R;
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002068
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002069 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002070 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002071 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
2072 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002073
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002074 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2075 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002076 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002077 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2078 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2079 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002080 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002081
2082 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002083 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002084
2085 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002086 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002087
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002088 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2089 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2090 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2091 LHS->getName()), I);
2092 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2093 }
2094 }
2095 }
2096
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002097 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2098 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002099 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002100 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002101 }
2102
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002103 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
2104 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
2105 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002106 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002107 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2108 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002109 if (!CI) {
2110 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2111 Other = LHS;
2112 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002113 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002114 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2115 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002116 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002117 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002118 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002119 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002120 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002121 }
2122 }
2123
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002124 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002125}
2126
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002127// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2128// highest order bit set.
2129static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002130 uint32_t NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer5a1e3e12007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002131 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002132}
2133
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002134Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002135 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002136
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002137 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2138 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002139
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002140 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002141 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002142 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002143
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002144 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2146 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2147 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2148
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002149 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2150 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002151 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2152 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002153
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002154 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002155 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002156 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002157 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2158
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002159 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2160 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002161 if (C->isZero()) {
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002162 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002163 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002164 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002165 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002166 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002167 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002168 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002169 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2170 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002171 }
2172 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002173 }
2174 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2175 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2176 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002177 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002178 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002179 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002180 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002181 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002182 }
2183 }
2184 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002185 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002186
2187 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2188 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002189 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002190 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002191
2192 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2193 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2194 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002195 }
2196
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002197 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2198 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002199 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002200 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002201 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002202 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002203 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002204 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2205 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2206 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002207 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002208 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2209 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002210 }
2211
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002212 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002213 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2214 // is not used by anyone else...
2215 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002216 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002217 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002218 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2219 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2220 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2221 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002222
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002223 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002224 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002225 }
2226
2227 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2228 //
2229 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2230 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2231 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2232
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002233 Value *NewNot =
2234 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002235 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002236 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002237
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002238 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002239 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002240 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002241 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002242 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002243 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002244 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2245
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002246 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002247 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002248 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002249 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002250 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002251 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002252 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002253 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002254
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002255 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002256 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2257 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002258 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2260 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2261 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002262 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2263 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2264 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002265 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002266
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002267 ConstantInt *C1;
2268 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002269 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2270 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002271
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002272 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2273 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002274 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002275 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002276 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002277}
2278
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002279/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2280/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2281/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2282/// signed.
2283static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2284 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002285 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002286 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2287 TrueIfSigned = true;
2288 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002289 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2290 TrueIfSigned = true;
2291 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002292 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2293 TrueIfSigned = false;
2294 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002295 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2296 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2297 TrueIfSigned = true;
2298 return RHS->getValue() ==
2299 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2300 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2301 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2302 TrueIfSigned = true;
2303 return RHS->getValue() ==
2304 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002305 default:
2306 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002307 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002308}
2309
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002310Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002311 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002312 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002313
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002314 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2315 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2316
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002317 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002318 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2319 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002320
2321 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002322 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002323 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2324 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002325 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2326 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002327
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002328 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2330 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2331 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2332 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner0af1fab2003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002333 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002334
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002335 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002336 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002337 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002338 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002339 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002340 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002341 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2342 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002343
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002344 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2345 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2346 if (Op1F->getValue() == 1.0)
2347 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2348 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002349
2350 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2351 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2352 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2353 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2354 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2355 Op1, "tmp");
2356 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2357 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2358 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2359 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2360
2361 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002362
2363 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2364 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002365 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002366 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002367
2368 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2369 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2370 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002371 }
2372
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002373 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2374 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002375 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002376
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002377 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2378 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2379 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2380 // formed.
2381 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002382 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002383 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002384 BoolCast = CI;
2385 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002386 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002387 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002388 BoolCast = CI;
2389 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002390 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002391 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2392 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002393 bool TIS = false;
2394
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002395 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002396 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2397 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002398 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2399 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002400 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002401 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002402 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002403 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002404 InsertNewInstBefore(
2405 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002406 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2407 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002408
2409 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2410 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002411 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002412 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2413 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002414 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2415 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2416 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2417 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2418 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002419
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002420 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002421 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002422 }
2423 }
2424 }
2425
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002426 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002427}
2428
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002429/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2430/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2431/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2432/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002433Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002434 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002435
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002436 // undef / X -> 0
2437 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002438 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002439
2440 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002441 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002443
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002444 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002445 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2446 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002447 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2448 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002449 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002450 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002451 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2452 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2453 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2454 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002455 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002456 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2457 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2458 else
2459 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2460 return &I;
2461 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002462
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002463 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2464 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2465 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2466 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2467 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002468 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002469 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2470 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2471 else
2472 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2473 return &I;
2474 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002475 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002476
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002477 return 0;
2478}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002479
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002480/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2481/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2482/// division instructions.
2483/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002484Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002485 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2486
2487 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2488 return Common;
2489
2490 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2491 // div X, 1 == X
2492 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2493 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2494
2495 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2496 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2497 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2498 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2499 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002500 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002501 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002502
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002503 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002504 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2505 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2506 return R;
2507 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2508 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2509 return NV;
2510 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002511 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002512
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002513 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002514 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002515 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2516 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2517
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002518 return 0;
2519}
2520
2521Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2522 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2523
2524 // Handle the integer div common cases
2525 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2526 return Common;
2527
2528 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2529 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2530 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2531 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002532 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002533 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002534 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002535 }
2536
2537 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002538 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002539 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2540 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002541 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002542 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002543 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002544 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002545 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002546 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2547 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002548 }
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002549 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002550 }
2551 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002552 }
2553
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002554 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2555 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002556 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002557 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002558 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002559 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002560 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002561 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002562 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002563 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2564 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2565 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2566 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2567 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2568
2569 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2570 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2571 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2572 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2573 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002574
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002575 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2576 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002577 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002578 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002579 return 0;
2580}
2581
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002582Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2583 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2584
2585 // Handle the integer div common cases
2586 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2587 return Common;
2588
2589 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2590 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2591 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2592 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2593
2594 // -X/C -> X/-C
2595 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2596 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2597 }
2598
2599 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2600 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002601 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002602 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002603 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2604 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2605 }
2606 }
2607
2608 return 0;
2609}
2610
2611Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2612 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2613}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002614
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002615/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2616/// of some factor, return that factor.
2617static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2618 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2619 return CI;
2620
2621 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2622 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2623
2624 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2625 if (!I) return Result;
2626
2627 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2628 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2629 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2630 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2631 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2632 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2633 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2634 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2635 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2636 }
2637 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2638 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2639 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002640 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002641 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2642 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002643 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002644 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002645 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002646 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002647 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2648 return Result;
2649 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2650 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002651 }
2652 return Result;
2653}
2654
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002655/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2656/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2657/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2658/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2659Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002660 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002661
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002662 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2663 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2664 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2666
2667 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2668 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2669 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2670 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002671
2672 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2673 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2674 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2675 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2676 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2677 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2678 // simplified also.
2679 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2680 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2681 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2682 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002683 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002684 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2685 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2686 else
2687 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002688 return &I;
2689 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002690 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2691 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2692 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2693 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2694 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002695 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002696 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2697 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2698 else
2699 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2700 return &I;
2701 }
Chris Lattner11a49f22005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002702 }
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002703
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002704 return 0;
2705}
2706
2707/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2708/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2709/// remainder instructions.
2710/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2711Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2712 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2713
2714 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2715 return common;
2716
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002717 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002718 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2719 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2720 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2721
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002722 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2724
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002725 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2726 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2727 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2728 return R;
2729 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2730 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2731 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002732 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002733 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2734 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002736 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002737 }
2738
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002739 return 0;
2740}
2741
2742Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2743 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2744
2745 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2746 return common;
2747
2748 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2749 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2750 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2751 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2752 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002753 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002754 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2755 }
2756
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002757 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002758 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2759 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2760 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002761 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002762 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2763 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2764 "tmp"), I);
2765 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2766 }
2767 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002768 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002769
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002770 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2771 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2772 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2773 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2774 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2775 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002776 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2777 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002778 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2779 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2780 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2781 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2782 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2783 }
2784 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002785 }
2786
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002787 return 0;
2788}
2789
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002790Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2791 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2792
2793 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2794 return common;
2795
2796 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2797 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002798 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002799 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2800 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2801 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2802 return &I;
2803 }
2804
2805 // If the top bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2806 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002807 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002808 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2809 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2810 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2811 }
2812
2813 return 0;
2814}
2815
2816Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002817 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2818}
2819
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002820// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002821static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spencer3a2a9fb2007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002822 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002823 if (!isSigned)
2824 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
2825 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits)-1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002826}
2827
2828// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002829static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002830 if (!isSigned)
2831 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
2832
2833 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2834 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2835 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits)+1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002836}
2837
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002838// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2839// constant.
2840static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002841 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002842}
2843
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002844// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2845// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2846static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002847 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002848}
2849
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002850/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002851/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2852///
2853/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2854///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002855/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2856/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002857///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002858/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2859/// 0 A > B
2860/// 1 A == B
2861/// 2 A < B
2862///
2863/// <=> Value Definition
2864/// 000 0 Always false
2865/// 001 1 A > B
2866/// 010 2 A == B
2867/// 011 3 A >= B
2868/// 100 4 A < B
2869/// 101 5 A != B
2870/// 110 6 A <= B
2871/// 111 7 Always true
2872///
2873static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2874 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002875 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002876 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2877 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2880 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2884 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002886 // True -> 7
2887 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002888 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002889 return 0;
2890 }
2891}
2892
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002893/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2894/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
2895/// new /// ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
2896/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2897static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2898 switch (code) {
2899 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002900 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002901 case 1:
2902 if (sign)
2903 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2904 else
2905 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2906 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2907 case 3:
2908 if (sign)
2909 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2910 else
2911 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2912 case 4:
2913 if (sign)
2914 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2915 else
2916 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2917 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2918 case 6:
2919 if (sign)
2920 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2921 else
2922 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002923 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002924 }
2925}
2926
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002927static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2928 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2929 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2930 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2931 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2932 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2933}
2934
2935namespace {
2936// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2937struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002938 InstCombiner &IC;
2939 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002940 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2941 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2942 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2943 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002944 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002945 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2946 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2947 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2948 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002949 return false;
2950 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002951 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2952 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2953 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2954 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2955 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002956 }
2957
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002958 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002959 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002960 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002961 unsigned Code;
2962 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2963 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2964 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2965 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002966 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002967 }
2968
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002969 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
2970 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
2971
2972 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002973 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2974 return I;
2975 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
2976 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
2977 }
2978};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00002979} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002980
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002981// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
2982// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002983// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002984Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002985 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
2986 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002987 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
2988 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00002989 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002990 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002991 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002992
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002993 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
2994 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002995 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002996 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002997 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002998 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002999 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003000 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003001 }
3002 break;
3003 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003004 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003006
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003007 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3008 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003009 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003010 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003011 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003012 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003013 }
3014 break;
3015 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003016 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003017 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3018 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3019 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003020 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003021
3022 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003023 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003024 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3025 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3026 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003027 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003028
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003029 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3030 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3031 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3032 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3033 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3034 // no effect.
3035 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3036 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3037 return &TheAnd;
3038 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003039 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003040 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003041 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003042 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003043 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003044 }
3045 }
3046 }
3047 }
3048 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003049
3050 case Instruction::Shl: {
3051 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3052 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3053 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003054 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003055 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003056 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3057 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003058
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003059 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3060 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3062 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003063 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3064 return &TheAnd;
3065 }
3066 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003067 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003068 case Instruction::LShr:
3069 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003070 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3071 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3072 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3073 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003074 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003075 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003076 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3077 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003078
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003079 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3080 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003081 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3082 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3083 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3084 return &TheAnd;
3085 }
3086 break;
3087 }
3088 case Instruction::AShr:
3089 // Signed shr.
3090 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3091 // with an and.
3092 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003093 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003094 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003095 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3096 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003097 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003098 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003099 // Make the argument unsigned.
3100 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003101 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003102 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003103 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003104 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003105 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003106 }
3107 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003108 }
3109 return 0;
3110}
3111
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003112
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003113/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3114/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003115/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3116/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003117/// insert new instructions.
3118Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003119 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3120 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003121 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003122 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003123 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003124
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003125 if (Inside) {
3126 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003127 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003128
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003129 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003130 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003131 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003132 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3133 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3134 }
3135
3136 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3137 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3138 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003139 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003140 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3141 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003142 }
3143
3144 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003145 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003146
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003147 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003148 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003149 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003150 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3151 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3152 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3153 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003154
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003155 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3156 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3157 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003158 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003159 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003160 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3161 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003162}
3163
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003164// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3165// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3166// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3167// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003168static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003169 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003170 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3171 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003172
3173 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003174 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003175 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003176 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003177 return true;
3178}
3179
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003180/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3181/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3182/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003183///
3184/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3185/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3186/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3187///
3188/// return (A +/- B).
3189///
3190Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003191 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003192 Instruction &I) {
3193 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3194 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3195 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3196
3197 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3198
3199 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3200 default: return 0;
3201 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003202 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003203 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003204 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3205 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3206 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003207 break;
3208
3209 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3210 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3211 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003212 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003213 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003214 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003215 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003216 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003217 break;
3218 }
3219 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003220 return 0;
3221 case Instruction::Or:
3222 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003223 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003224 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3225 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003226 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003227 break;
3228 return 0;
3229 }
3230
3231 Instruction *New;
3232 if (isSub)
3233 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3234 else
3235 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3236 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3237}
3238
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003239Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003240 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003241 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003242
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003243 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3245
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003246 // and X, X = X
3247 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003249
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003250 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003251 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003252 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003253 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3254 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3255 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003256 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003257 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003258 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003259 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003260 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003261 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003262 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3263 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003264 }
3265 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003266
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003267 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003268 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3269 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003270
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003271 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003272 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003273 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003274 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3275 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3276 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3277 case Instruction::Xor:
3278 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003279 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3280 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3281 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3282 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3283 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3284 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3285 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3286 return BinaryOperator::create(
3287 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003288 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003289 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003290 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3291 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3292 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3293 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3294 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3295 return BinaryOperator::create(
3296 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3297 }
3298 }
3299
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003300 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003301 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003302 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3303 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3304 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3305 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3306 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3307 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3308 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003309 break;
3310
3311 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003312 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3313 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3314 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3315 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3316 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003317 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003318 }
3319
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003320 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003321 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003322 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003323 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003324 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3325 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3326 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3327 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003328 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003329 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner7560c3a2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003330 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003331 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3332 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003333 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3334 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3335 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003336 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3337 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3338 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003339 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003340 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003341 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003342 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003343 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3344 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3345 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3346 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003347 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003348 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3349 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3350 }
3351 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003352 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003353
3354 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3355 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003356 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003357 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003358 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3359 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3360 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003361 }
3362
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003363 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3364 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003365
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003366 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3368
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003369 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003370 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003371 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3372 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003373 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003374 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3375 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003376
3377 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003378 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3379 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003380 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3381 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003382
3383 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3384 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3385 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3386 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3387 }
3388 }
3389
3390 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003391 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003393
3394 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3395 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3396 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3397 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3398 }
3399 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003400
3401 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3402 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3403 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3404 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3405 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3406 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3407 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3408 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3409 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3410 }
3411 }
3412 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3413 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3414 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3415 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3416 std::swap(A, B);
3417 }
3418 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3419 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3420 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3421 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3422 }
3423 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003424 }
3425
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003426 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3427 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3428 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003429 return R;
3430
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003431 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3432 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003433 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3434 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3435 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3436 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3437 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3438 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3439 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3440 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3441 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003442 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003443 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3444 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3445 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3446 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003447 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003448 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3449 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3450 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3451 }
3452
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003453 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003454 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3455 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003456 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3457 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3458 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003459 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3460
3461 switch (LHSCC) {
3462 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003463 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003464 switch (RHSCC) {
3465 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003466 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3467 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3468 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003469 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003470 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3471 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3472 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003473 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3474 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003475 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003476 switch (RHSCC) {
3477 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003478 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3479 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3480 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3481 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3482 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3483 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3484 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3485 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3486 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3487 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3488 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003489 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3491 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003492 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3493 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3494 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3495 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003496 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3497 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003498 }
3499 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3500 }
3501 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003502 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003503 switch (RHSCC) {
3504 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003505 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3506 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003507 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3509 break;
3510 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003512 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003513 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3514 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003515 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003516 break;
3517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003518 switch (RHSCC) {
3519 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003520 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3521 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003522 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003523 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3524 break;
3525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3526 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003527 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3529 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003530 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003531 break;
3532 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3533 switch (RHSCC) {
3534 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3535 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3537 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3538 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3539 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3540 break;
3541 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3542 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3543 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3544 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3546 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3547 true, I);
3548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3549 break;
3550 }
3551 break;
3552 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3553 switch (RHSCC) {
3554 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3555 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3556 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3558 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3560 break;
3561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3562 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3563 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3564 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3565 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3566 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3567 true, I);
3568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3569 break;
3570 }
3571 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003572 }
3573 }
3574 }
3575
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003576 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003577 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3578 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3579 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3580 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003581 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003582 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003583 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3584 I.getType(), TD) &&
3585 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3586 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003587 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3588 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3589 I.getName());
3590 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3591 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3592 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003593 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003594
3595 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003596 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3597 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3598 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003599 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3600 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3601 Instruction *NewOp =
3602 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3603 SI1->getOperand(0),
3604 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003605 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3606 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003607 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003608 }
3609
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003610 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003611}
3612
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003613/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3614/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3615/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003616static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003617 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3618 if (I == 0) return true;
3619
3620 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3621 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3622 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3623 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3624
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003625 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003626 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3627 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003628 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003629 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003630 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003631 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3632 return true;
3633
3634 unsigned DestNo;
3635 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3636 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3637 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3638 } else {
3639 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3640 DestNo = 0;
3641 }
3642
3643 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3644 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3645 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3646 return true;
3647 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3648 return false;
3649 }
3650
3651 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3652 // don't have this.
3653 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3654 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3655 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3656 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3657 return true;
3658 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3659
3660 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003661 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3662 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003663 return true;
3664
3665 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3666 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003667 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3668 return true;
3669 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003670 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003671 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003672 break;
3673 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3674 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3675
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003676 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003677 unsigned SrcByte;
3678 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3679 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3680 else
3681 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3682
3683 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3684 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3685 return true;
3686
3687 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3688 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3689 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3690 return true;
3691 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3692 return false;
3693}
3694
3695/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3696/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3697Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003698 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3699 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3700 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003701
3702 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3703 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003704 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003705 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003706
3707 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3708 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3709 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3710 return 0;
3711
3712 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3713 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3714 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3715
3716 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3717 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3718 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3719 return 0;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003720 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy, ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003721 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003722 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 2);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003723 return new CallInst(F, V);
3724}
3725
3726
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003727Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003728 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003729 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003730
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003731 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003732 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003733
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003734 // or X, X = X
3735 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003736 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003737
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003738 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3739 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003740 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3741 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3742 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3743 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3744 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3745 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003746 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3748 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3749 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003751 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003752
3753
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003754
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003755 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003756 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003757 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003758 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3759 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003760 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003761 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003762 Or->takeName(Op0);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003763 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or,
3764 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003765 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003766
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003767 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3768 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003769 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003770 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003771 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003772 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003773 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003774 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003775
3776 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3777 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003778 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003779 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003780 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3781 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3782 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003783 }
3784
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003785 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3786 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003787
3788 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3789 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3791 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3792 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3793 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3794
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003795 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3796 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003797 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003798 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3799 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3800 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003801 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3802 return BSwap;
3803 }
3804
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003805 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3806 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003807 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003808 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3809 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3810 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3811 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003812 }
3813
3814 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3815 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003816 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003817 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3818 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3819 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3820 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003821 }
3822
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003823 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00003824 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003825 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
3826 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003827 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
3828 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
3829 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
3830 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
3831 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3832 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3833 // replace with V+N.
3834 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
3835 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
3836 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3837 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3838 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
3839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3840 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
3841 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3842 }
3843 // Or commutes, try both ways.
3844 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
3845 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3846 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3847 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
3848 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3849 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
3850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3851 }
3852 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003853 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003854 }
3855
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003856 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
3857 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003858 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3859 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
3860 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
3861 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
3862 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
3863 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
3864 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
3865 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
3866 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
3867
3868 if (V1) {
3869 Value *Or =
3870 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
3871 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003872 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003873 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003874 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003875
3876 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003877 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3878 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3879 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003880 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3881 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3882 Instruction *NewOp =
3883 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3884 SI1->getOperand(0),
3885 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003886 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3887 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003888 }
3889 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003890
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003891 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3892 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003893 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003894 } else {
3895 A = 0;
3896 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003897 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003898 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3899 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003901
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003902 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003903 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3904 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3905 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3906 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3907 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003908 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003909
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003910 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3911 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3912 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003913 return R;
3914
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003915 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3916 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003917 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3918 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3919 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3920 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3921 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3922 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3923 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3924 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003925 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3926 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
3927 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003928 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003929 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003930 bool NeedsSwap;
3931 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003932 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003933 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003934 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003935
3936 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003937 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3938 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3939 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3940 }
3941
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003942 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003943 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3944 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003945 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3946 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003947 // equal.
3948 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3949
3950 switch (LHSCC) {
3951 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003952 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003953 switch (RHSCC) {
3954 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003955 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003956 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3957 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3958 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3959 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3960 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003961 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003962 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003963 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003964 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
3965 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
3966 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00003967 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003968 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3969 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
3970 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003971 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3972 }
3973 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003974 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003975 switch (RHSCC) {
3976 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003977 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
3978 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
3979 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003980 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003981 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
3982 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
3983 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003984 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003985 }
3986 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003987 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003988 switch (RHSCC) {
3989 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003990 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003991 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003992 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
3993 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
3994 false, I);
3995 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3996 break;
3997 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3998 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003999 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004000 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4001 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004002 }
4003 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004004 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004005 switch (RHSCC) {
4006 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004007 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4008 break;
4009 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
4010 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4011 false, I);
4012 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4013 break;
4014 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4015 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4016 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4017 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4018 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004019 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004020 break;
4021 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4022 switch (RHSCC) {
4023 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4024 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4025 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4026 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4027 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4028 break;
4029 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4030 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004031 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004032 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4033 break;
4034 }
4035 break;
4036 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4037 switch (RHSCC) {
4038 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4039 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4040 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4041 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4042 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4043 break;
4044 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4045 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004046 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004047 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4048 break;
4049 }
4050 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004051 }
4052 }
4053 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004054
4055 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004056 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004057 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004058 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
4059 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004060 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004061 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004062 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4063 I.getType(), TD) &&
4064 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4065 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004066 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4067 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4068 I.getName());
4069 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4070 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4071 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004072 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004073
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004074
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004075 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004076}
4077
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004078// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4079struct XorSelf {
4080 Value *RHS;
4081 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4082 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4083 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4084 return &Xor;
4085 }
4086};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004087
4088
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004089Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004090 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004091 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004092
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004093 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
4094 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
4095
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004096 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4097 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
4098 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?");
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004099 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004100 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004101
4102 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4103 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004104 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4105 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4106 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4107 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4108 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4109 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004110 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4111 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004112 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004113
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004114 // Is this a ~ operation?
4115 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4116 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4117 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4118 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4119 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4120 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4121 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4122 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4123 Instruction *NotY =
4124 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
4125 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4126 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4127 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
4128 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4129 else
4130 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4131 }
4132 }
4133 }
4134 }
4135
4136
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004137 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004138 // xor (icmp A, B), true = not (icmp A, B) = !icmp A, B
4139 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004140 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && ICI->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004141 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4142 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004143
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004144 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004145 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004146 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4147 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004148 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4149 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004150 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004151 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004152 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004153
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004154 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004155 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004156 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004157 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004158 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4159 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4160 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004161 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004162 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004163 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004164 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4165 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
4166 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004167
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004168 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004169 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4170 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004171 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004172 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4173 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4174 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004175 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004176 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4177 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004178 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004179 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4180 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4181 return &I;
4182 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004183 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004184 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004185
4186 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4187 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004188 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004189 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004190 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4191 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4192 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004193 }
4194
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004195 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004196 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004197 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004198
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004199 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004200 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004201 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004202
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004203
4204 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4205 if (Op1I) {
4206 Value *A, *B;
4207 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4208 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004209 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004210 I.swapOperands();
4211 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004212 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004213 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004214 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004215 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004216 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4217 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4218 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4219 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4221 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004222 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004223 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004224 std::swap(A, B);
4225 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004226 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004227 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4228 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4229 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004230 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004231 }
4232
4233 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4234 if (Op0I) {
4235 Value *A, *B;
4236 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4237 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4238 std::swap(A, B);
4239 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4240 Instruction *NotB =
4241 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4242 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004243 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004244 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4245 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4246 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4247 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4249 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4250 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4251 std::swap(A, B);
4252 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004253 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004254 Instruction *N =
4255 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004256 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4257 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004258 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004259 }
4260
4261 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4262 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4263 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4264 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4265 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4266 Instruction *NewOp =
4267 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4268 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4269 Op0I->getName()), I);
4270 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4271 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4272 }
4273
4274 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4275 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4276 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4277 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4278 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4279 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4280 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4281 }
4282 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4283 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4284 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4285 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4286 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4287 }
4288
4289 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4290 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4291 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4292 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4293 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4294 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4295 if (A == C)
4296 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4297 else if (A == D)
4298 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4299 else if (B == C)
4300 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4301 else if (B == D)
4302 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4303
4304 if (X) {
4305 Instruction *NewOp =
4306 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4307 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4308 }
4309 }
4310 }
4311
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004312 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4313 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4314 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004315 return R;
4316
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004317 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004318 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004319 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004320 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4321 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004322 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004323 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004324 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4325 I.getType(), TD) &&
4326 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4327 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004328 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4329 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4330 I.getName());
4331 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4332 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4333 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004334 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004335
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004336 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004337}
4338
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004339/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4340/// overflowed for this type.
4341static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004342 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004343 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004344
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004345 if (IsSigned)
4346 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4347 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4348 else
4349 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4350 else
4351 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004352}
4353
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004354/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4355/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4356/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4357static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4358 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4359 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004360 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4361 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004362
4363 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004364 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSize()*8;
4365 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004366
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004367 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4368 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattner0b84c802005-01-13 23:26:48 +00004369 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004370 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4371 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4372
4373 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4374 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4375 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4376
4377 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4378 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004379 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004380 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4381 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result,
4382 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4383 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4384 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004385 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004386
4387 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4388 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4389 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4390 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4391 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4392 else {
4393 // Emit an add instruction.
4394 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4395 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4396 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004397 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004398 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004399 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004400 // Convert to correct type.
4401 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4402 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4403 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4404 else
4405 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4406 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4407 }
4408 if (Size != 1) {
4409 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4410 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4411 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4412 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4413 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4414 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4415 }
4416
4417 // Emit an add instruction.
4418 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4419 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4420 cast<Constant>(Result));
4421 else
4422 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
4423 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004424 }
4425 return Result;
4426}
4427
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004428/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004429/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004430Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4431 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4432 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004433 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004434
4435 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4436 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4437 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4438
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004439 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4440 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4441 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004442 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4443 // each index is zero or not.
4444 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004445 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004446 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4447 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004448 bool EmitIt = true;
4449 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4450 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4451 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4452 if (C->isNullValue())
4453 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004454 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
4455 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004456 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004457 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004458 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4459 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004460 }
4461
4462 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004463 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004464 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004465 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4466 if (InVal == 0)
4467 InVal = Comp;
4468 else {
4469 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4470 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004471 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004472 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4473 else // True if all are equal
4474 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4475 }
4476 }
4477 }
4478
4479 if (InVal)
4480 return InVal;
4481 else
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004482 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004483 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4484 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004485 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004486
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004487 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004488 // the result to fold to a constant!
4489 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4490 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4491 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004492 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4493 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004494 }
4495 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004496 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4497 // compare the base pointer.
4498 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4499 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004500 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004501 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004502 if (IndicesTheSame)
4503 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4504 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4505 IndicesTheSame = false;
4506 break;
4507 }
4508
4509 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4510 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004511 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4512 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004513
4514 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4515 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004516 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004517 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004518
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004519 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4520 bool AllZeros = true;
4521 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4522 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4523 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4524 AllZeros = false;
4525 break;
4526 }
4527 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004528 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4529 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004530
4531 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004532 AllZeros = true;
4533 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4534 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4535 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4536 AllZeros = false;
4537 break;
4538 }
4539 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004540 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004541
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004542 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4543 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4544 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4545 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4546 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4547 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004548 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4549 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004550 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004551 NumDifferences = 2;
4552 break;
4553 } else {
4554 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4555 DiffOperand = i;
4556 }
4557 }
4558
4559 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4560 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004561 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4562 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004563 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004564 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4565 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004566 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4567 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004568 }
4569 }
4570
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004571 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004572 // the result to fold to a constant!
4573 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4574 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4575 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4576 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4577 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004578 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004579 }
4580 }
4581 return 0;
4582}
4583
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004584Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4585 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004586 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004587
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004588 // Fold trivial predicates.
4589 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4590 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4591 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4592 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4593
4594 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4595 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4596 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4597 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4598 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4599 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4600 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4601 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4602 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4603 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4604 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4605 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4606
4607 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4608 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4609 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4610 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4611 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4612 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4613 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4614 return &I;
4615
4616 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4617 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4618 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4619 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4620 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4621 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4622 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4623 return &I;
4624 }
4625 }
4626
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004627 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004628 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004629
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004630 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4631 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4632 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4633 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4634 case Instruction::PHI:
4635 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4636 return NV;
4637 break;
4638 case Instruction::Select:
4639 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4640 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4641 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4642 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4643 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4644 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4645 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4646 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4647 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4648 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4649 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4650 I.getName()), I);
4651 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4652 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4653 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4654 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4655 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4656 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4657 I.getName()), I);
4658 }
4659 }
4660
4661 if (Op1)
4662 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4663 break;
4664 }
4665 }
4666
4667 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4668}
4669
4670Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4671 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4672 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4673 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4674
4675 // icmp X, X
4676 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4678 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004679
4680 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004681 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004682
4683 // icmp of GlobalValues can never equal each other as long as they aren't
4684 // external weak linkage type.
4685 if (GlobalValue *GV0 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op0))
4686 if (GlobalValue *GV1 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op1))
4687 if (!GV0->hasExternalWeakLinkage() || !GV1->hasExternalWeakLinkage())
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004688 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4689 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004690
4691 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004692 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004693 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4694 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4695 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004696 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004697 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4698 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004699
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004700 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004701 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004702 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4703 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004705 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004706 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004707 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004708 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004709 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004710 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004711
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004712 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4713 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4714 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004715 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004716 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4717 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004718 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4719 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4720 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4721 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004722 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4723 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4724 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004725 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004726 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4727 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004728 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4729 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4730 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4731 }
4732 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004733 }
4734
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004735 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4736 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004737 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004738 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4739 default: break;
4740 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4741 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004743 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4744 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4745 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4746 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004747 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
4748 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
4749 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
4750 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
4751
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004752 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004753
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004754 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4755 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004757 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4758 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4759 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4760 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4761 break;
4762
4763 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4764 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004766 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4767 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4768 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4769 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004770
4771 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
4772 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
4773 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
4774 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004775 break;
4776
4777 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4778 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004779 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004780 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4781 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4782 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4783 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4784 break;
4785
4786 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4787 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004789 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4790 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4791 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4792 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4793 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004794
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004795 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4796 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004797 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004798 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4799 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4800 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4801 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4802 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004803
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004804 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4805 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004807 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4808 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4809 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4810 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4811 break;
4812
4813 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4814 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004816 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4817 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4818 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4819 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4820 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004821 }
4822
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004823 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4824 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004825 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4826 //
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004827 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004828 default: break;
4829 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4830 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4831 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4832 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4833 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4834 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4835 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4836 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004837 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004838
4839 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004840 // in the input. If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
4841 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
4842
4843 bool UnusedBit;
4844 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
4845
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004846 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4847 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004848 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
4849 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
4850 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004851 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4852 return &I;
4853
4854 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4855 // in.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004856 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004857 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4858 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004859 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
4860 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004861 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004862 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4863 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004864 } else {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004865 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4866 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004867 }
4868 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4869 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4870 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004871 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004872 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004873 break;
4874 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004875 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004877 break;
4878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004879 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004880 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004881 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004882 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004883 break;
4884 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004885 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004886 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004887 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004888 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004889 break;
4890 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004891 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004892 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004893 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004894 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004895 break;
4896 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004897 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004898 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004899 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004901 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004902 }
4903 }
4904
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004905 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004906 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004907 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004908 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004909 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
4910 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004911 }
4912
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004913 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004914 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4915 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4916 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004917 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
4918 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004919 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004920 bool isAllZeros = true;
4921 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4922 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
4923 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4924 isAllZeros = false;
4925 break;
4926 }
4927 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004928 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004929 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
4930 }
4931 break;
4932
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004933 case Instruction::PHI:
4934 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4935 return NV;
4936 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004937 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004938 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4939 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4940 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4941 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4942 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4943 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4944 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004945 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4946 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4947 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4948 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4949 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004950 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4951 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004952 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4953 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4954 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4955 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4956 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004957 }
4958 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00004959
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004960 if (Op1)
4961 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4962 break;
4963 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004964 case Instruction::Malloc:
4965 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
4966 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
4967 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
4968 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
4969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4970 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
4971 }
4972 break;
4973 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004974 }
4975
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004976 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004977 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004978 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004979 return NI;
4980 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004981 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
4982 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004983 return NI;
4984
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004985 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004986 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
4987 // now.
4988 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
4989 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
4990 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004991 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
4992 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004993 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004994
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004995 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
4996 // so eliminate it as well.
4997 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
4998 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004999
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005000 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005001 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005002 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005003 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005004 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005005 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005006 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005007 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005008 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005009 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005010 }
5011
5012 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005013 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005014 // This comes up when you have code like
5015 // int X = A < B;
5016 // if (X) ...
5017 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005018 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5019 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005020 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005021 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005022 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005023
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005024 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005025 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5026 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5027 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5028 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5029 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5030 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5031 }
5032
5033 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5034 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5035 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5036 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5037 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005038 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005039 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5040 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5041 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5042 }
5043
5044 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5045 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5046 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5047 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5048 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5049 }
5050 }
5051
5052 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5053 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005054 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5055 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005056 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5057 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005058 }
5059 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005060 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005061 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5062 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005063 }
5064 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005065 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005066 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5067 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005068 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005069
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005070 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5071 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5072 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5073 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5074 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5075
5076 if (A == C) {
5077 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5078 } else if (A == D) {
5079 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5080 } else if (B == C) {
5081 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5082 } else if (B == D) {
5083 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5084 }
5085
5086 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5087 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5088 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5089 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5090 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5091 return &I;
5092 }
5093 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005094 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005095 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005096}
5097
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005098
5099/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5100/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5101Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5102 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5103 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5104 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5105
5106 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5107 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5108 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5109 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5110 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5111 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5112 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5113 // if it finds it.
5114 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5115 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5116 return 0;
5117 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005118 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005119
5120 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5121 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5122 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5123 // instead of computing a divide.
5124 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5125
5126 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5127 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5128 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5129 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5130 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5131
5132 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005133 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005134
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005135 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5136 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5137 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5138 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5139 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5140 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5141 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5142 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5143 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5144
5145
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005146 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005147 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005148 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005149 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5150 if (!HiOverflow)
5151 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005152 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
5153 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005154 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005155 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5156 HiBound = DivRHS;
5157 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005158 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5159 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5160 if (!HiOverflow)
5161 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005162 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005163 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005164 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5165 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005166 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005167 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005168 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005169 }
5170 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
5171 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005172 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005173 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5174 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005175 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5176 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5177 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5178 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005179 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005180 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5181 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005182 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005183 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005184 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5185 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005186 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005187 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005188 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005189 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5190 }
5191
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005192 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5193 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005194 }
5195
5196 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005197 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005198 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5199 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5200 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5201 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5202 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005203 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005204 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5205 else if (LoOverflow)
5206 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5207 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5208 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005209 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005210 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5211 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5212 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5213 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005214 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005215 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5216 else if (LoOverflow)
5217 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5218 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5219 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005220 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005221 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5222 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005223 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5224 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5225 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005226 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005227 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005228 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5229 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005230 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005231 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005232 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5234 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005235 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5236 else
5237 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5238 }
5239}
5240
5241
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005242/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5243///
5244Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5245 Instruction *LHSI,
5246 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5247 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5248
5249 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005250 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005251 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5252 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5253 // fold the xor.
5254 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0 ||
5255 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue()) {
5256 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5257
5258 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5259 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5260 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5261 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5262 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5263 return &ICI;
5264 }
5265
5266 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5267 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5268
5269 // If so, the new one isn't.
5270 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5271
5272 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5273 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5274 else
5275 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5276 }
5277 }
5278 break;
5279 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5280 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5281 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5282 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5283
5284 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5285 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5286 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5287 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5288 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5289 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5290 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5291 // bit would not work.
5292 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
5293 (ICI.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
5294 RHSV.isPositive())) {
5295 uint32_t BitWidth =
5296 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5297 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5298 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5299 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5300 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5301 Instruction *NewAnd =
5302 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
5303 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5304 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5305 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5306 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5307 }
5308 }
5309
5310 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5311 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5312 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5313 // access.
5314 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5315 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5316 Shift = 0;
5317
5318 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5319 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5320 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5321 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5322
5323 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5324 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5325 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5326 if (ShAmt) {
5327 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5328 if (!CanFold) {
5329 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5330 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5331 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5332 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5333
5334 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5335 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5336 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5337 CanFold = true;
5338 }
5339
5340 if (CanFold) {
5341 Constant *NewCst;
5342 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5343 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5344 else
5345 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5346
5347 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5348 // compared.
5349 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5350 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5351 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5352 // result is always true or false now.
5353 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5354 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5355 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5356 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5357 } else {
5358 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5359 Constant *NewAndCST;
5360 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5361 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5362 else
5363 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5364 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5365 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5366 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5367 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5368 return &ICI;
5369 }
5370 }
5371 }
5372
5373 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5374 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5375 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5376 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5377 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5378 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5379 // Compute C << Y.
5380 Value *NS;
5381 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5382 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
5383 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5384 } else {
5385 // Insert a logical shift.
5386 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
5387 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5388 }
5389 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5390
5391 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5392 Instruction *NewAnd =
5393 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
5394 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5395
5396 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5397 return &ICI;
5398 }
5399 }
5400 break;
5401
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005402 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5403 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5404 if (!ShAmt) break;
5405
5406 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5407
5408 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5409 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5410 // simplified.
5411 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5412 break;
5413
5414 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5415 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5416 // comparison cannot succeed.
5417 Constant *Comp =
5418 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5419 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5420 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5421 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5422 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5423 }
5424
5425 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5426 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5427 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5428 Constant *Mask =
5429 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005430
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005431 Instruction *AndI =
5432 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5433 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5434 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5435 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5436 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005437 }
5438 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005439
5440 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5441 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5442 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5443 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5444 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5445 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5446 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5447 Instruction *AndI =
5448 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5449 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5450 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5451
5452 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5453 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5454 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005455 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005456 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005457
5458 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005459 case Instruction::AShr: {
5460 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5461 if (!ShAmt) break;
5462
5463 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5464 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5465 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5466 // simplified.
5467 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5468 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5469 break;
5470 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5471
5472 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5473 // comparison cannot succeed.
5474 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5475 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5476 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5477 else
5478 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5479
5480 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5481 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5482 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5483 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5484 }
5485
5486 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || RHSV == 0) {
5487 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5488 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5489 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005490
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005491 Instruction *AndI =
5492 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5493 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5494 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5495 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5496 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005497 }
5498 }
5499 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005500 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005501
5502 case Instruction::SDiv:
5503 case Instruction::UDiv:
5504 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5505 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5506 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
5507 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
5508 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
5509 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005510 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
5511 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
5512 DivRHS))
5513 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005514 break;
5515 }
5516
5517 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
5518 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5519 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5520
5521 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5522 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
5523 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
5524 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
5525 case Instruction::SRem:
5526 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
5527 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
5528 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
5529 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
5530 Instruction *NewRem =
5531 BinaryOperator::createURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
5532 BO->getName());
5533 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
5534 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5535 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
5536 }
5537 }
5538 break;
5539 case Instruction::Add:
5540 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5541 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5542 if (BO->hasOneUse())
5543 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5544 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
5545 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
5546 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5547 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5548 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
5549
5550 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
5551 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
5552 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
5553 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
5554 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
5555 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
5556 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
5557 Neg->takeName(BO);
5558 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
5559 }
5560 }
5561 break;
5562 case Instruction::Xor:
5563 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5564 // the explicit xor.
5565 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5566 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5567 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
5568
5569 // FALLTHROUGH
5570 case Instruction::Sub:
5571 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
5572 if (RHSV == 0)
5573 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5574 BO->getOperand(1));
5575 break;
5576
5577 case Instruction::Or:
5578 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5579 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
5580 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5581 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
5582 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
5583 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5584 isICMP_NE));
5585 }
5586 break;
5587
5588 case Instruction::And:
5589 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5590 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5591 // comparison can never succeed!
5592 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
5593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5594 isICMP_NE));
5595
5596 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
5597 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
5598 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5599 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
5600 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
5601
5602 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
5603 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5604 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5605 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5606 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5607 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5608 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
5609 }
5610
5611 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
5612 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5613 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5614 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
5615 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5616 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5617 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
5618 }
5619 }
5620 default: break;
5621 }
5622 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
5623 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5624 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
5625 AddToWorkList(II);
5626 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
5627 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
5628 return &ICI;
5629 }
5630 }
5631 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00005632 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
5633 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005634 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
5635 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5636 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
5637 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5638 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
5639 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
5640 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5641 // smaller constant values.
5642 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
5643 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5644 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
5645 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
5646 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
5647 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
5648 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5649 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5650 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5651 }
5652 }
5653 }
5654 }
5655 return 0;
5656}
5657
5658/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
5659/// We only handle extending casts so far.
5660///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005661Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5662 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005663 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5664 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005665 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005666 Value *RHSCIOp;
5667
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005668 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
5669 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
5670 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
5671 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
5672 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
5673 Value *RHSOp = 0;
5674 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00005675 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005676 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
5677 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
5678 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
5679 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
5680 RHSOp = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, RHSOp,
5681 LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
5682 }
5683
5684 if (RHSOp)
5685 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
5686 }
5687
5688 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
5689 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005690 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5691 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005692 return 0;
5693
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005694 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5695 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005696
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005697 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005698 // Not an extension from the same type?
5699 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005700 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5701 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005702
5703 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5704 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5705 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5706 return 0;
5707
5708 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5709 // then we can't handle this.
5710 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5711 return 0;
5712
5713 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5714 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005715 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005716
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005717 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5718 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5719 if (!CI)
5720 return 0;
5721
5722 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5723 // reextended to DestTy.
5724 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5725 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5726
5727 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5728 if (Res2 == CI) {
5729 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5730 // For example, we might have:
5731 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5732 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5733 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5734 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5735 // because %A may have negative value.
5736 //
5737 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5738 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005739 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005740 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5741 else
5742 return 0;
5743 }
5744
5745 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5746 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5747
5748 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5749 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5750 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005752 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005754
5755 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5756 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5757 Value *Result;
5758 if (isSignedCmp) {
5759 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005760 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005761 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005762 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005763 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005764 } else {
5765 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5766 if (isSignedExt) {
5767 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5768 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005769 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005770 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5771 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5772 } else {
5773 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005774 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005775 }
5776 }
5777
5778 // Finally, return the value computed.
5779 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5780 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5781 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5782 } else {
5783 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5784 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5785 "ICmp should be folded!");
5786 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5788 else
5789 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5790 }
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005791}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005792
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005793Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5794 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5795}
5796
5797Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5798 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5799}
5800
5801Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5802 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5803}
5804
5805Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5806 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005807 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005808
5809 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5810 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005811 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005812 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5813 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005814
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005815 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5816 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005818 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005819 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5820 }
5821 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005822 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5823 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5824 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005826 }
5827
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005828 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5829 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005830 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005831 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5833
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005834 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5835 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5836 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005837 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005838 return R;
5839
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005840 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005841 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005842 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5843 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005844 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005845 }
5846 }
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005847
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005848 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005849 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5850 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005851 return 0;
5852}
5853
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005854Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005855 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005856 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005857
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005858 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5859 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005860 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5861 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5862 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005863 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5864 return &I;
5865
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005866 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5867 // of a signed value.
5868 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005869 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005870 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5872 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005873 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005874 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005875 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005876 }
5877
5878 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5879 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5880 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5881 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5882 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5883 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5884
5885 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5886 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5887 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5888 return R;
5889 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5890 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5891 return NV;
5892
5893 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005894 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5895 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5896 Value *V1, *V2;
5897 ConstantInt *CC;
5898 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005899 default: break;
5900 case Instruction::Add:
5901 case Instruction::And:
5902 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005903 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005904 // These operators commute.
5905 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005906 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5907 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005908 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005909 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005910 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005911 Op0BO->getName());
5912 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005913 Instruction *X =
5914 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5915 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005916 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005917 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005918 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5919 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005920 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005921
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005922 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005923 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005924 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005925 match(Op0BOOp1,
5926 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005927 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5928 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005929 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005930 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5931 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005932 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5933 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005934 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005935 V1->getName()+".mask");
5936 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5937
5938 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
5939 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005940 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005941
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005942 // FALL THROUGH.
5943 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005944 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005945 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5946 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005947 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005948 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005949 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5950 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005951 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005952 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005953 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005954 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005955 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005956 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005957 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5958 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005959 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005960
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005961 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005962 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5963 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
5964 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005965 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005966 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
5967 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005968 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005969 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5970 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005971 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5972 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005973 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005974 V1->getName()+".mask");
5975 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5976
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005977 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005978 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005979
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005980 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005981 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005982 }
5983
5984
5985 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
5986 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
5987 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
5988 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
5989 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
5990
5991 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005992 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00005993 case Instruction::Add:
5994 isValid = isLeftShift;
5995 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005996 case Instruction::Or:
5997 case Instruction::Xor:
5998 highBitSet = false;
5999 break;
6000 case Instruction::And:
6001 highBitSet = true;
6002 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006003 }
6004
6005 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6006 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6007 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6008 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6009 // operation.
6010 //
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006011 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006012 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006013 }
6014
6015 if (isValid) {
6016 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6017
6018 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006019 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006020 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006021 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006022
6023 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
6024 NewRHS);
6025 }
6026 }
6027 }
6028 }
6029
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006030 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006031 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6032 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6033 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006034
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006035 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006036 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006037 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6038 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006039 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6040 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6041 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006042
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006043 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006044 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6045 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006046
6047 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6048
6049 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006050 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006051 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
6052 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6053 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6054 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6055 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
6056 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6057 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6058 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6059 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6060 Instruction *Shift =
6061 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6062 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6063
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006064 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006065 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006066 }
6067
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006068 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6069 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6070 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6071 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6072 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006073 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006074 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006075 }
6076 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6077 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006078 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006079 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006080 }
6081 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6082 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6083 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6084 // generators.
6085 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6086 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006087 case 1 :
6088 case 8 :
6089 case 16 :
6090 case 32 :
6091 case 64 :
6092 case 128:
6093 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6094 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006095 default: break;
6096 }
6097 if (SExtType) {
6098 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6099 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6100 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6101 }
6102 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6103 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006104 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006105
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006106 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006107 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6108 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6109 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006110 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006111 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006112 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6113
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006114 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
6115 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006116 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006117
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006118 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006119 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6120 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6121 Instruction *Shift =
6122 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6123 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006124
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006125 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006126 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006127 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006128
6129 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6130 } else {
6131 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006132 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006133
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006134 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006135 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6136 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6137 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6138 Instruction *Shift =
6139 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
6140 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6141 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6142
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006143 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006144 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006145 }
6146
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006147 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006148 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6149 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6150 Instruction *Shift =
6151 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6152 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6153
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006154 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006155 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006156 }
6157
6158 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006159 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006160 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006161 return 0;
6162}
6163
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006164
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006165/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6166/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6167/// X*Scale+Offset.
6168///
6169static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006170 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006171 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006172 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006173 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
6174 Scale = 1;
6175 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006176 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val)) {
6177 if (I->getNumOperands() == 2) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006178 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006179 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6180 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6181 Scale = 1U << CUI->getZExtValue();
6182 Offset = 0;
6183 return I->getOperand(0);
6184 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6185 // This value is scaled by 'CUI'.
6186 Scale = CUI->getZExtValue();
6187 Offset = 0;
6188 return I->getOperand(0);
6189 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6190 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6191 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6192 unsigned SubScale;
6193 Value *SubVal =
6194 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6195 Offset += CUI->getZExtValue();
6196 if (SubScale > 1 && (Offset % SubScale == 0)) {
6197 Scale = SubScale;
6198 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006199 }
6200 }
6201 }
6202 }
6203 }
6204
6205 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6206 Scale = 1;
6207 Offset = 0;
6208 return Val;
6209}
6210
6211
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006212/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6213/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006214Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006215 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006216 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006217
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006218 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6219 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006220
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006221 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6222 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6223 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6224 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6225 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6226
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006227 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006228 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006229 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006230 }
6231 }
6232
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006233 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6234 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6235 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6236 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006237
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006238 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6239 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006240 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6241
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006242 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6243 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6244 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6245 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6246
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006247 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
6248 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006249 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006250
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006251 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6252 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006253 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6254 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006255 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6256 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6257
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006258 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6259 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006260 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6261 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006262
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006263 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6264 Value *Amt = 0;
6265 if (Scale == 1) {
6266 Amt = NumElements;
6267 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006268 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006269 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6270 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006271 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006272 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006273 else if (Scale != 1) {
6274 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
6275 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006276 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006277 }
6278
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006279 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6280 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006281 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
6282 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6283 }
6284
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006285 AllocationInst *New;
6286 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006287 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006288 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006289 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006290 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006291 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006292
6293 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6294 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6295 // die soon.
6296 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6297 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006298 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6299 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6300 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006301 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6302 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6303 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006304 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6305}
6306
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006307/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006308/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6309/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6310/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6311/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6312///
6313/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6314/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6315static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006316 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006317 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6318 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6319 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006320
6321 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006322 if (!I) return false;
6323
6324 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006325
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006326 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6327 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6328 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6329 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6330 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6331 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6332 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6333 // casts first.
6334 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
6335 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6336 return true;
6337 }
6338 }
6339
6340 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6341 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6342 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6343
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006344 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006345 case Instruction::Add:
6346 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006347 case Instruction::And:
6348 case Instruction::Or:
6349 case Instruction::Xor:
6350 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006351 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6352 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6353 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6354 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006355
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006356 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006357 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6358 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6359 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006360 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6361 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6362 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006363 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6364 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006365 }
6366 break;
6367 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006368 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6369 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6370 // already zeros.
6371 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006372 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6373 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6374 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006375 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006376 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6377 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006378 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6379 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006380 }
6381 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006382 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006383 case Instruction::ZExt:
6384 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006385 case Instruction::Trunc:
6386 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
6387 // can safely eliminate it.
6388 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006389 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6390 return true;
6391 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006392 break;
6393 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006394 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6395 break;
6396 }
6397
6398 return false;
6399}
6400
6401/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6402/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6403/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006404Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006405 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006406 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006407 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006408
6409 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6410 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006411 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006412 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006413 case Instruction::Add:
6414 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006415 case Instruction::And:
6416 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006417 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006418 case Instruction::AShr:
6419 case Instruction::LShr:
6420 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006421 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006422 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6423 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6424 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006425 break;
6426 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006427 case Instruction::Trunc:
6428 case Instruction::ZExt:
6429 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006430 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006431 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
6432 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006433 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6434 return I->getOperand(0);
6435
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006436 // Otherwise, must be the same type of case, so just reinsert a new one.
6437 Res = CastInst::create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
6438 Ty, I->getName());
6439 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006440 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006441 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6442 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6443 break;
6444 }
6445
6446 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6447}
6448
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006449/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6450Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006451 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6452
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00006453 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006454 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006455 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006456 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6457 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6458 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6459 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6460 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006461 }
6462 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006463
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006464 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006465 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6466 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6467 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006468
6469 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006470 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6471 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6472 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006473
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006474 return 0;
6475}
6476
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006477/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
6478Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6479 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6480
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006481 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006482 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6483 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006484 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
6485 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6486 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6487 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006488 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006489 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6490 return &CI;
6491 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006492
6493 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
6494 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
6495 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
6496 // non-type-safe code.
6497 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
6498 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
6499 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
6500 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
6501 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
6502
6503 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
6504 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
6505 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
6506 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
6507 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
6508 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
6509
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006510 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
6511 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
6512 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006513 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006514 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
6515 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
6516 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
6517 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006518
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006519 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
6520 if (Offset < 0) {
6521 --FirstIdx;
6522 Offset += TySize;
6523 assert(Offset >= 0);
6524 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00006525 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006526 }
6527
6528 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006529
6530 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
6531 while (Offset) {
6532 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6533 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006534 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
6535 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
6536 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006537
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006538 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
6539 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
6540 } else {
6541 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6542 Offset = 0;
6543 OrigBase = 0;
6544 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006545 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6546 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006547 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeSize(STy->getElementType())) {
6548 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
6549 Offset %= EltSize;
6550 } else {
6551 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
6552 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006553 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
6554 } else {
6555 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6556 Offset = 0;
6557 OrigBase = 0;
6558 }
6559 }
6560 if (OrigBase) {
6561 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
6562 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
6563 // two.
6564 Instruction *NGEP = new GetElementPtrInst(OrigBase, &NewIndices[0],
6565 NewIndices.size(), "");
6566 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
6567 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
6568
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006569 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
6570 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6571 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
6572 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6573 }
6574 }
6575 }
6576 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006577 }
6578
6579 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6580}
6581
6582
6583
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006584/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6585/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006586/// cases.
6587/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6588Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6589 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6590 return Result;
6591
6592 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6593 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6594 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006595 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6596 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006597
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006598 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6599 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006600 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6601 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006602 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6603 return &CI;
6604
6605 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6606 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006607 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6608 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006609 return 0;
6610
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006611 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006612 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006613 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6614 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006615 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006616 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006617 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
6618 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
6619 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
6620 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006621 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006622 bool DoXForm;
6623 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6624 default:
6625 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6626 // get here because of the check above.
6627 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6628 case Instruction::Trunc:
6629 DoXForm = true;
6630 break;
6631 case Instruction::ZExt:
6632 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6633 break;
6634 case Instruction::SExt:
6635 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6636 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006637 }
6638
6639 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006640 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6641 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006642 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6643 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6644 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6645 case Instruction::Trunc:
6646 case Instruction::BitCast:
6647 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6648 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6649 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6650 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6651 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00006652 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
6653 SrcBitSize));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006654 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6655 }
6656 case Instruction::SExt:
6657 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6658 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006659 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6660 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006661 }
6662 }
6663 }
6664
6665 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6666 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6667
6668 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6669 case Instruction::Add:
6670 case Instruction::Mul:
6671 case Instruction::And:
6672 case Instruction::Or:
6673 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006674 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006675 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6676 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6677 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6678 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6679 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006680 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6681 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006682 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006683 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6684 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6685 return BinaryOperator::create(
6686 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006687 }
6688 }
6689
6690 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6691 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6692 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006693 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006694 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006695 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006696 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6697 }
6698 break;
6699 case Instruction::SDiv:
6700 case Instruction::UDiv:
6701 case Instruction::SRem:
6702 case Instruction::URem:
6703 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6704 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6705 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6706 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6707 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006708 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6709 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006710 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6711 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6712 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6713 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006714 return BinaryOperator::create(
6715 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6716 }
6717 }
6718 break;
6719
6720 case Instruction::Shl:
6721 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6722 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6723 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6724 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6725 // in the value.
6726 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6727 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006728 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6729 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6730 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006731 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006732 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006733 }
6734 break;
6735 case Instruction::AShr:
6736 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6737 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6738 // simplifications.
6739 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6740 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006741 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006742 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6743 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006744 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006745 }
6746 }
6747 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006748 }
6749 return 0;
6750}
6751
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006752Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006753 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6754 return Result;
6755
6756 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6757 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006758 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6759 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006760
6761 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6762 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6763 default: break;
6764 case Instruction::LShr:
6765 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6766 // are already zeros.
6767 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006768 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006769
6770 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006771 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006772 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6773 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006774 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6775 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6776
6777 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6778 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006779 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6780 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6781 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006782 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006783 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006784 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6785
6786 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6787 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6788 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006789 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006790 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6791
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006792 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006793 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006794 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006795 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6796 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6797 "tmp"), CI);
6798 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006799 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006800 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006801 }
6802 break;
6803 }
6804 }
6805
6806 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006807}
6808
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006809Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006810 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6811 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6812 return Result;
6813
6814 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6815
6816 // If this is a cast of a cast
6817 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006818 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6819 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6820 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6821 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6822 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6823 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006824 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6825 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6826 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006827 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6828 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6829 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006830 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006831 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006832 Instruction *And =
6833 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6834 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6835 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6836 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6837 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006838 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006839 }
6840 return And;
6841 }
6842 }
6843 }
6844
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006845 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6846 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6847 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6848 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6849 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006850 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006851
6852 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
6853 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
6854 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6855 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6856 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6857 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6858 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6859 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createLShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006860 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006861 CI);
6862 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6863 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6864 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6865
6866 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
6867 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6868 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006869 In->getName()+".not"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006870 CI);
6871 }
6872
6873 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6874 }
6875
6876
6877
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006878 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6879 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6880 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6881 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6882 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6883 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6884 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6885 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006886 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
6887 // This only works for EQ and NE
6888 ICI->isEquality()) {
6889 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
6890 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
6891 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6892 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
6893 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6894
6895 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
6896 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
6897 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6898 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
6899 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6900 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
6901 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
6902 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
6903 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6904 }
6905
6906 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
6907 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6908 if (ShiftAmt) {
6909 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6910 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6911 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
6912 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
6913 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6914 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
6915 }
6916
6917 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
6918 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6919 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6920 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6921 }
6922
6923 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6924 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6925 else
6926 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
6927 }
6928 }
6929 }
6930 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006931 return 0;
6932}
6933
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006934Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006935 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6936 return I;
6937
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006938 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6939
6940 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
6941 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
6942 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6943 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6944 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6945 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6946 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
6947 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
6948
6949 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
6950 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
6951 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6952 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6953 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6954 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6955 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6956 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006957 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006958 CI);
6959 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6960 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6961 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6962
6963 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
6964 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(In,
6965 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
6966
6967 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6968 }
6969 }
6970 }
6971
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006972 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006973}
6974
6975Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
6976 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6977}
6978
6979Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
6980 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6981}
6982
6983Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006984 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006985}
6986
6987Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006988 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006989}
6990
6991Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6992 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6993}
6994
6995Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6996 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6997}
6998
6999Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007000 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007001}
7002
7003Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
7004 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7005}
7006
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007007Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007008 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7009 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7010 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7011 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7012 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7013
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007014 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007015 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7016 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007017 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7018 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7019 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007020 } else {
7021 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7022 return Result;
7023 }
7024
7025
7026 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7027 // be replaced by the operand.
7028 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7029 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7030
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007031 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007032 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7033 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7034 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7035
7036 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7037 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7038 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7039 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7040 return V;
7041
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007042 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7043 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007044 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7045 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7046 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7047 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7048 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7049 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7050 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7051 ++NumZeros;
7052 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007053
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007054 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7055 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7056 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
7057 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, &Idxs[0], Idxs.size());
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007058 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007059 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007060
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007061 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7062 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7063 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7064 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007065 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7066 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007067 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7068 CastInst *Tmp;
7069 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7070 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7071 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7072 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7073 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7074 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7075 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007076 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7077 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7078 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7079 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007080 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7081 // know the vector types match #elts.
7082 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007083 }
7084 }
7085 }
7086 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007087 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007088}
7089
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007090/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7091/// %C = or %A, %B
7092/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7093/// into:
7094/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7095/// %D = or %A, %C
7096///
7097/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7098/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7099/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7100///
7101static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7102 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7103 case Instruction::Add:
7104 case Instruction::Mul:
7105 case Instruction::And:
7106 case Instruction::Or:
7107 case Instruction::Xor:
7108 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7109 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7110 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007111 case Instruction::LShr:
7112 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007113 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007114 default:
7115 return 0; // Cannot fold
7116 }
7117}
7118
7119/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
7120/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
7121static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
7122 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7123 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
7124 case Instruction::Add:
7125 case Instruction::Sub:
7126 case Instruction::Or:
7127 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007128 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007129 case Instruction::LShr:
7130 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007131 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007132 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00007133 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007134 case Instruction::Mul:
7135 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
7136 }
7137}
7138
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007139/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
7140/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
7141Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
7142 Instruction *FI) {
7143 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
7144 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
7145 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007146 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007147 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
7148 return 0;
7149 } else {
7150 return 0; // unknown unary op.
7151 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007152
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007153 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
7154 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
7155 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
7156 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007157 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
7158 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007159 }
7160
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007161 // Only handle binary operators here.
7162 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007163 return 0;
7164
7165 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
7166 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
7167 bool MatchIsOpZero;
7168 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7169 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7170 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7171 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7172 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7173 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7174 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7175 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7176 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7177 MatchIsOpZero = false;
7178 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
7179 return 0;
7180 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7181 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7182 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7183 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7184 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7185 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7186 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7187 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7188 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7189 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7190 } else {
7191 return 0;
7192 }
7193
7194 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
7195 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
7196 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
7197 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
7198
7199 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
7200 if (MatchIsOpZero)
7201 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
7202 else
7203 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007204 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007205 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
7206 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007207}
7208
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007209Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007210 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
7211 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
7212 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
7213
7214 // select true, X, Y -> X
7215 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007216 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007217 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007218
7219 // select C, X, X -> X
7220 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
7221 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7222
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007223 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
7224 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7225 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
7226 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7227 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
7228 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7229 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7230 else
7231 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7232 }
7233
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007234 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007235 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007236 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007237 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007238 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007239 } else {
7240 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
7241 Value *NotCond =
7242 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7243 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007244 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007245 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007246 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007247 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007248 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007249 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007250 } else {
7251 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
7252 Value *NotCond =
7253 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7254 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007255 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007256 }
7257 }
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007258 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007259
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007260 // Selecting between two integer constants?
7261 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
7262 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007263 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007264 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007265 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007266 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007267 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007268 Value *NotCond =
7269 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007270 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007271 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007272 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007273
7274 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007275
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007276 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007277
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007278 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007279 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007280 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007281 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007282 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007283 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007284 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007285 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007286 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
7287 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
7288 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007289 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
7290
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007291 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
7292 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
7293 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007294 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7295 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007296 if (SRASize < SISize)
7297 opc = Instruction::SExt;
7298 else if (SRASize > SISize)
7299 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
7300 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007301 }
7302 }
7303
7304
7305 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007306 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007307 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
7308 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007309 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00007310 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007311 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
7312 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
7313 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007314 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
7315 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
7316 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007317 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
7318 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007319 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
7320 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007321 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007322 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007323 Value *V = ICA;
7324 if (ShouldNotVal)
7325 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
7326 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
7327 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
7328 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007329 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007330 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007331
7332 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007333 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7334 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007335 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007336 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7338 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007339 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007340 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7341 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7342
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007343 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007344 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007345 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007347 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007348 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
7349 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7350 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7351 }
7352 }
7353
7354 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
7355 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7356 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
7357 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
7358 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7360 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
7361 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
7362 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7363 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7364
7365 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
7366 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
7367 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7369 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
7370 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007371 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007372 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7373 }
7374 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007375
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007376 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7377 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7378 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007379 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
7380
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007381 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
7382 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
7383 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
7384 return IV;
7385
7386 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
7387 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007388 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7389 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7390 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
7391 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7392 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7393 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
7394 }
7395
7396 if (AddOp) {
7397 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
7398 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
7399 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
7400 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
7401 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
7402 }
7403
7404 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007405 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
7406 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
7407 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
7408 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
7409 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
7410 } else {
7411 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
7412 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007413 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007414
7415 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
7416 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
7417 if (AddOp != TI)
7418 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
7419 Instruction *NewSel =
7420 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
7421
7422 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
7423 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007424 }
7425 }
7426 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007427
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007428 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007429 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007430 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7431 // transformation we are doing here.
7432 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7433 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7434 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7435 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7436 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7437 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7438 OpToFold = 1;
7439 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7440 OpToFold = 2;
7441 }
7442
7443 if (OpToFold) {
7444 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007445 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007446 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007447 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007448 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007449 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7450 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007451 else {
7452 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7453 }
7454 }
7455 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007456
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007457 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7458 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7459 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7460 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7461 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7462 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7463 OpToFold = 1;
7464 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7465 OpToFold = 2;
7466 }
7467
7468 if (OpToFold) {
7469 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007470 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007471 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007472 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007473 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007474 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7475 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007476 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007477 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007478 }
7479 }
7480 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007481
7482 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7483 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7484 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7485 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7486 return &SI;
7487 }
7488
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007489 return 0;
7490}
7491
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007492/// GetKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that we can
7493/// determine, return it, otherwise return 0.
7494static unsigned GetKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD) {
7495 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7496 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
7497 if (Align == 0 && TD)
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007498 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007499 return Align;
7500 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7501 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7502 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7503 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007504 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007505 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7506 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007507 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007508 Align =
7509 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007510 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007511 Align =
7512 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007513 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007514 }
7515 }
7516 return Align;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007517 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007518 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007519 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007520 User *CI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007521 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
7522 return GetKnownAlignment(CI->getOperand(0), TD);
7523 return 0;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007524 } else if (User *GEPI = dyn_castGetElementPtr(V)) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007525 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD);
7526 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7527
7528 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7529 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7530 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7531 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7532 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7533 AllZeroOperands = false;
7534 break;
7535 }
7536 if (AllZeroOperands)
7537 return BaseAlignment;
7538
7539 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7540 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7541 // least as much as its type requires.
7542 if (!TD) return 0;
7543
7544 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007545 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007546 unsigned Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType());
7547 if (Align <= BaseAlignment) {
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007548 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007549 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007550 Align = std::min(Align, (unsigned)
7551 TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType()));
7552 return Align;
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007553 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007554 return 0;
7555 }
7556 return 0;
7557}
7558
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007559
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007560/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7561/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7562/// the heavy lifting.
7563///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007564Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007565 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7566 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7567
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007568 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7569 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007570 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007571 bool Changed = false;
7572
7573 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7574 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7575 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7576
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007577 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007578 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007579 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7580 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7581 // alignment is sufficient.
7582 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007583 }
7584
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007585 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7586 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7587 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007588 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007589 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7590 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7591 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007592 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth8ed4c472006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007593 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007594 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007595 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7596 else
7597 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattner92141962007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007598 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007599 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7600 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7601 Changed = true;
7602 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007603 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007604
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007605 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7606 // set, update the alignment.
7607 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
7608 unsigned Alignment1 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7609 unsigned Alignment2 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
7610 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007611 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007612 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007613 Changed = true;
7614 }
7615 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
7616 unsigned Alignment = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007617 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007618 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007619 Changed = true;
7620 }
7621 }
7622
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007623 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007624 } else {
7625 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7626 default: break;
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007627 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7628 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007629 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7630 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7631 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7632 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7633 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007634 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007635 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007636 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007637 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7638 }
7639 break;
7640 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7641 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7642 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7643 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007644 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007645 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7646 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007647 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7648 }
7649 break;
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007650 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7651 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7652 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7653 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7654 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7655 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
7656 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007657 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7658 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007659 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7660 }
7661 break;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007662
7663 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7664 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7665 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7666 uint64_t UndefElts;
7667 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7668 UndefElts)) {
7669 II->setOperand(1, V);
7670 return II;
7671 }
7672 break;
7673 }
7674
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007675 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7676 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007677 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007678 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7679
7680 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7681 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7682 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7683 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7684 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7685 AllEltsOk = false;
7686 break;
7687 }
7688 }
7689
7690 if (AllEltsOk) {
7691 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007692 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7693 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7694 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7695 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007696 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7697
7698 // Only extract each element once.
7699 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7700 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7701
7702 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7703 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7704 continue;
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007705 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007706 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7707
7708 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7709 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007710 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007711 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7712 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7713 }
7714
7715 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007716 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007717 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7718 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007719 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007720 }
7721 }
7722 break;
7723
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007724 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7725 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7726 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7727 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7728 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7729 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7730 if (&*++BI == II)
7731 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7732 }
7733 }
7734
7735 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7736 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7737 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7738 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7739 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7740 bool CannotRemove = false;
7741 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7742 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7743 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7744 CannotRemove = true;
7745 break;
7746 }
7747 }
7748 if (!CannotRemove)
7749 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7750 }
7751 break;
7752 }
7753 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007754 }
7755
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007756 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007757}
7758
7759// InvokeInst simplification
7760//
7761Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007762 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007763}
7764
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007765// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7766//
7767Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007768 bool Changed = false;
7769
7770 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7771 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007772 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7773
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007774 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007775
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007776 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7777 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7778 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7779 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7780 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007781 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007782 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007783 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7784 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7785 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7786 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7787 return 0;
7788 }
7789
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007790 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7791 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7792 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7793 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007794 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007795 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007796 CS.getInstruction());
7797
7798 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7799 CS.getInstruction()->
7800 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7801
7802 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7803 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7804 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007805 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007806 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007807 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7808 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007809
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007810 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7811 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7812 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7813 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7814 // the call.
7815 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7816 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7817 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7818 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7819 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7820 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007821 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007822 *I = Op;
7823 Changed = true;
7824 }
7825 }
7826 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007827
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007828 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007829}
7830
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007831// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7832// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7833//
7834bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7835 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7836 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007837 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7838 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007839 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00007840 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007841 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7842
7843 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
7844 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
7845 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
7846 //
7847 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
7848 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
7849
Chris Lattnera2b18de2007-05-19 06:51:32 +00007850 const FunctionType *ActualFT =
7851 cast<FunctionType>(cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType());
7852
7853 // If the parameter attributes don't match up, don't do the xform. We don't
7854 // want to lose an sret attribute or something.
7855 if (FT->getParamAttrs() != ActualFT->getParamAttrs())
7856 return false;
7857
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007858 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
7859 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007860 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007861 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
7862 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
7863 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007864 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007865
7866 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
7867 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
7868 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
7869 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
7870 if (!Caller->use_empty())
7871 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
7872 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
7873 UI != E; ++UI)
7874 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
7875 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007876 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007877 return false;
7878 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007879
7880 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
7881 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007882
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007883 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
7884 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
7885 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007886 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007887 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00007888 //Some conversions are safe even if we do not have a body.
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007889 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007890 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007891 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007892 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007893 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
7894 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00007895 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007896 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00007897
7898 // Most other conversions can be done if we have a body, even if these
7899 // lose information, e.g. int->short.
7900 // Some conversions cannot be done at all, e.g. float to pointer.
7901 // Logic here parallels CastInst::getCastOpcode (the design there
7902 // requires legality checks like this be done before calling it).
7903 if (ParamTy->isInteger()) {
7904 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7905 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7906 return false;
7907 }
7908 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint() &&
7909 !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
7910 return false;
7911 } else if (ParamTy->isFloatingPoint()) {
7912 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7913 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7914 return false;
7915 }
7916 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint())
7917 return false;
7918 } else if (const VectorType *VParamTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ParamTy)) {
7919 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7920 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != VParamTy->getBitWidth())
7921 return false;
7922 }
7923 if (VParamTy->getBitWidth() != ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7924 return false;
7925 } else if (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy)) {
7926 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
7927 return false;
7928 } else {
7929 return false;
7930 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007931 }
7932
7933 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007934 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007935 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
7936
7937 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
7938 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
7939 std::vector<Value*> Args;
7940 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
7941
7942 AI = CS.arg_begin();
7943 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7944 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
7945 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
7946 Args.push_back(*AI);
7947 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007948 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007949 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007950 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007951 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007952 }
7953 }
7954
7955 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
7956 // now...
7957 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
7958 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
7959
7960 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
7961 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
7962 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00007963 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
7964 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007965 } else {
7966 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
7967 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7968 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
7969 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
7970 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007971 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
7972 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007973 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007974 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
7975 Args.push_back(Cast);
7976 } else {
7977 Args.push_back(*AI);
7978 }
7979 }
7980 }
7981
7982 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007983 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007984
7985 Instruction *NC;
7986 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007987 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Chris Lattner93e985f2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00007988 &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00007989 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007990 } else {
David Greene52eec542007-08-01 03:43:44 +00007991 NC = new CallInst(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00007992 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
7993 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattnere4370262005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007994 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007995 }
7996
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007997 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007998 Value *NV = NC;
7999 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8000 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008001 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008002 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
8003 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008004 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00008005
8006 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
8007 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
8008 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8009 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
8010 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
8011 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
8012 } else {
8013 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
8014 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
8015 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008016 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008017 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00008018 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008019 }
8020 }
8021
8022 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8023 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00008024 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008025 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008026 return true;
8027}
8028
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008029/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
8030/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
8031/// and a single binop.
8032Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8033 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008034 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
8035 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008036 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008037 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8038 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
8039
8040 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
8041 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008042
8043 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
8044 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008045 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008046 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008047 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008048 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008049 // types or GEP's with different index types.
8050 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
8051 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008052 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008053
8054 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
8055 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
8056 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
8057 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
8058 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008059
8060 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
8061 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
8062 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008063 }
8064
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008065 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
8066
8067 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
8068 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
8069 // hide them behind a phi.
8070 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
8071 return 0;
8072
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008073 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008074 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008075 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008076 if (LHSVal == 0) {
8077 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
8078 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8079 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008080 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
8081 LHSVal = NewLHS;
8082 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008083
8084 if (RHSVal == 0) {
8085 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
8086 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8087 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008088 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
8089 RHSVal = NewRHS;
8090 }
8091
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008092 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
8093 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8094 if (NewLHS) {
8095 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8096 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8097 }
8098 if (NewRHS) {
8099 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
8100 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8101 }
8102 }
8103
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008104 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008105 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008106 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8107 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
8108 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008109 else {
8110 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
8111 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
8112 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008113}
8114
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008115/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
8116/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
8117/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
8118/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008119///
8120/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
8121/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
8122/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008123static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
8124 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
8125
8126 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
8127 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
8128 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008129
8130 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
8131 // profitable to do this xform.
8132 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
8133 bool isAddressTaken = false;
8134 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
8135 UI != E; ++UI) {
8136 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
8137 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
8138 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
8139 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
8140 }
8141 isAddressTaken = true;
8142 break;
8143 }
8144
8145 if (!isAddressTaken)
8146 return false;
8147 }
8148
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008149 return true;
8150}
8151
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008152
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008153// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
8154// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
8155// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
8156Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8157 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
8158
8159 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
8160 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
8161 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
8162 // code size and simplifying code.
8163 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
8164 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008165 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008166 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
8167 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008168 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008169 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
8170 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008171 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008172 if (ConstantOp == 0)
8173 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008174 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
8175 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
8176 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
8177 // load and the PHI.
8178 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
8179 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8180 return 0;
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008181 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008182 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008183 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
8184 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
8185 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008186 } else {
8187 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
8188 }
8189
8190 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
8191 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8192 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
8193 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008194 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008195 return 0;
8196 if (CastSrcTy) {
8197 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
8198 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008199 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008200 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
8201 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008202 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
8203 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
8204 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8205 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008206 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
8207 return 0;
8208 }
8209 }
8210
8211 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
8212 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
8213 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
8214 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00008215 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008216
8217 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8218 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008219
8220 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008221 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8222 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8223 if (NewInVal != InVal)
8224 InVal = 0;
8225 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8226 }
8227
8228 Value *PhiVal;
8229 if (InVal) {
8230 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
8231 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
8232 PhiVal = InVal;
8233 delete NewPN;
8234 } else {
8235 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
8236 PhiVal = NewPN;
8237 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008238
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008239 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008240 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
8241 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008242 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008243 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008244 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008245 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008246 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8247 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
8248 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008249 else
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008250 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenca5183d2007-03-05 00:00:42 +00008251 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008252}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008253
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008254/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
8255/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008256static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
8257 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008258 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
8259 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
8260
8261 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008262 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008263 return true;
8264
8265 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
8266 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008267
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008268 return false;
8269}
8270
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008271// PHINode simplification
8272//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008273Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00008274 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00008275 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00008276
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008277 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
8278 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
8279
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008280 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
8281 // reducing code size.
8282 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
8283 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
8284 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
8285 return Result;
8286
8287 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
8288 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
8289 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008290 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
8291 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
8292 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008293 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008294 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
8295 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
8296 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8297 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008298
8299 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
8300 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
8301 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
8302 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
8303 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
8304 // late.
8305 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
8306 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
8307 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
8308 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8309 }
8310 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008311
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00008312 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008313}
8314
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008315static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
8316 Instruction *InsertPoint,
8317 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008318 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8319 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008320 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
8321 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
8322 // used for address computation.
8323 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
8324 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
8325 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
8326 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008327}
8328
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008329
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008330Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008331 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008332 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008333 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008334 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008335 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008336
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008337 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
8338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
8339
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008340 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
8341 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
8342 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
8343
8344 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008345 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008346
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008347 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
8348 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008349
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008350 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008351 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008352 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
8353 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00008354 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
8355 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
8356 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
8357 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
8358 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
8359 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8360 MadeChange = true;
8361 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008362 }
8363 }
8364 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008365 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
8366 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
8367 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
8368 // obvious.
8369 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008370 if (TD->getTypeSize(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008371 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008372 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008373 MadeChange = true;
8374 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008375 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
8376 GEP);
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008377 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
8378 MadeChange = true;
8379 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008380 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008381 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008382 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
8383
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008384 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
8385 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
8386 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008387 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008388 return new BitCastInst(cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))->getOperand(0),
8389 GEP.getType());
8390
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008391 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
8392 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
8393 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
8394 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008395 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00008396 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008397 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008398
8399 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008400 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
8401 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
8402 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
8403 //
8404 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
8405 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
8406 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
8407
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008408 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008409
8410 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
8411 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
8412 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
8413 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00008414 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008415
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008416 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008417 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00008418 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
8419 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
8420 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008421 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008422 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
8423 Sum = GO1;
8424 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
8425 Sum = SO1;
8426 } else {
8427 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
8428 // target's pointer size.
8429 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
8430 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008431 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008432 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008433 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008434 } else {
8435 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008436 if (TD->getTypeSize(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008437 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008438 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008439
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008440 } else if (TD->getTypeSize(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008441 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008442 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008443 } else {
8444 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008445 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
8446 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008447 }
8448 }
8449 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008450 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
8451 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
8452 else {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00008453 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
8454 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008455 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008456 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008457
8458 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
8459 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8460 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8461 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8462 return &GEP;
8463 } else {
8464 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8465 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8466 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8467 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8468 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008469 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008470 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008471 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008472 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008473 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8474 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008475 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8476 }
8477
8478 if (!Indices.empty())
Chris Lattner1ccd1852007-02-12 22:56:41 +00008479 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], &Indices[0],
8480 Indices.size(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008481
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008482 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008483 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8484 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8485
8486 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008487 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008488 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8489 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8490 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8491
8492 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008493 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8494 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008495
8496 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8498 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008499 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008500 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8501 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8502 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
8503 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
8504 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
8505 //
8506 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8507 //
8508 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8509 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8510 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8511 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8512 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8513 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8514 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8515 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8516 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8517 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8518 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8519 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8520 return &GEP;
8521 }
8522 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8523 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008524 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
8525 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008526 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
8527 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
8528 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
8529 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
8530 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
8531 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008532 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008533 GEP.getOperand(1), GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008534 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
8535 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008536 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008537
8538 // Transform things like:
8539 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
8540 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
8541 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
8542
8543 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008544 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008545 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
8546 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
8547
8548 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
8549 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
8550 Value *NewIdx = 0;
8551 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
8552 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
8553 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
8554 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
8555 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00008556 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008557 Scale = CI;
8558 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
8559 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
8560 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00008561 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8562 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
8563 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008564 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8565 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
8566 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
8567 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8568 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8569 }
8570 }
8571
8572 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
8573 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008574 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008575 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008576 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
8577 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
8578 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008579 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
8580 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008581 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
8582 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
8583 }
8584
8585 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008586 Instruction *NewGEP =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008587 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008588 NewIdx, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008589 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
8590 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
8591 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008592 }
8593 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008594 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008595 }
8596
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008597 return 0;
8598}
8599
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008600Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
8601 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
8602 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008603 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8604 const Type *NewTy =
8605 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008606 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008607
8608 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
8609 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008610 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008611 else {
8612 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008613 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008614 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008615
8616 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008617
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008618 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
8619 // allocas if possible...
8620 //
8621 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
8622 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
8623
8624 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
8625 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
8626 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008627 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattner693787a2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00008628 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, NullIdx, NullIdx,
8629 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008630
8631 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
8632 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008633 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008634 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8635 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008636 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008637
8638 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
8639 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
8640 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008641 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattnercf27afb2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00008642 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008643 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
8644
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008645 return 0;
8646}
8647
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008648Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
8649 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
8650
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008651 // free undef -> unreachable.
8652 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
8653 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008654 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008655 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008656 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8657 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00008658
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008659 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
8660 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008661 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008662 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00008663
8664 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
8665 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
8666 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
8667 return &FI;
8668 }
8669
8670 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
8671 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
8672 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8673 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
8674 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
8675 return &FI;
8676 }
8677 }
8678
8679 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
8680 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
8681 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
8682 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8683 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
8684 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008685
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008686 return 0;
8687}
8688
8689
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008690/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008691static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
8692 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008693 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008694
8695 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008696 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008697 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008698
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008699 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008700 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008701 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8702 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8703 // constants.
8704 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8705 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8706 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008707 Value *Idxs[2];
8708 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8709 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008710 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8711 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8712 }
8713
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008714 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008715 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +00008716 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
8717 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
8718 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008719 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8720 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008721
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008722 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
8723 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
8724 // the result of the loaded value.
8725 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
8726 CI->getName(),
8727 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
8728 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008729 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008730 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008731 }
8732 }
8733 return 0;
8734}
8735
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008736/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008737/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
8738/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
8739/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
8740static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
8741 // If it is an alloca or global variable, it is always safe to load from.
8742 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V) || isa<GlobalVariable>(V)) return true;
8743
8744 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
8745 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008746 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
8747 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
8748 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008749 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
8750
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008751 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008752 --BBI;
8753
8754 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8755 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
8756 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8757 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008758
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008759 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008760 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008761}
8762
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008763Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
8764 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +00008765
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00008766 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
8767 unsigned KnownAlign = GetKnownAlignment(Op, TD);
8768 if (KnownAlign > LI.getAlignment())
8769 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
8770
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008771 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008772 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008773 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8774 return Res;
8775
8776 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
8777 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008778
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008779 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
8780 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008781 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
8782 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008783 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8784 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
8785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008786 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
8787 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
8788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008789 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008790
8791 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008792 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008793 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8794 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8795 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8796 // CFG.
8797 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8798 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8800 }
8801
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008802 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008803 // load null/undef -> undef
8804 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008805 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
8806 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
8807 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008808 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8809 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008811 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008812
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008813 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
8814 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008815 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008817
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008818 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
8819 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
8820 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
8821 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008822 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +00008823 if (Constant *V =
8824 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008826 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
8827 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8828 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8829 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8830 // CFG.
8831 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8832 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8833 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8834 }
8835
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008836 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008837 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8838 return Res;
8839 }
8840 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +00008841
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008842 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008843 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
8844 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
8845 // exposes redundancy in the code.
8846 //
8847 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
8848 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
8849 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
8850 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
8851 // unconditionally.
8852 //
8853 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
8854 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008855 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
8856 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008857 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008858 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008859 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008860 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008861 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
8862 }
8863
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +00008864 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
8865 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
8866 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8867 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
8868 return &LI;
8869 }
8870
8871 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
8872 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
8873 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8874 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
8875 return &LI;
8876 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008877 }
8878 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008879 return 0;
8880}
8881
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +00008882/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008883/// when possible.
8884static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
8885 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
8886 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
8887
8888 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8889 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
8890 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8891
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008892 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008893 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8894 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8895 // constants.
8896 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8897 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8898 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008899 Value* Idxs[2];
8900 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8901 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008902 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8903 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8904 }
8905
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008906 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
8907 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8908 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008909
8910 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008911 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
8912 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008913 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008914 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008915 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
8916 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
8917 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
8918 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
8919 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008920 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008921 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008922 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008923 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
8924 }
8925 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008926 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008927 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008928 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008929 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
8930 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008931 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
8932 }
8933 }
8934 }
8935 return 0;
8936}
8937
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008938Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
8939 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
8940 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
8941
8942 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008943 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008944 ++NumCombined;
8945 return 0;
8946 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00008947
8948 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
8949 // alloca dead.
8950 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
8951 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
8952 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8953 ++NumCombined;
8954 return 0;
8955 }
8956
8957 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
8958 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
8959 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8960 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8961 ++NumCombined;
8962 return 0;
8963 }
8964 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008965
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00008966 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
8967 unsigned KnownAlign = GetKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD);
8968 if (KnownAlign > SI.getAlignment())
8969 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
8970
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008971 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
8972 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
8973 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
8974 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
8975 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
8976 --ScanInsts) {
8977 --BBI;
8978
8979 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
8980 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
8981 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8982 ++NumDeadStore;
8983 ++BBI;
8984 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
8985 continue;
8986 }
8987 break;
8988 }
8989
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008990 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
8991 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
8992 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
8993 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8994 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr) {
8995 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8996 ++NumCombined;
8997 return 0;
8998 }
8999 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
9000 // may not be dead.
9001 break;
9002 }
9003
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009004 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009005 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009006 break;
9007 }
9008
9009
9010 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009011
9012 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
9013 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
9014 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
9015 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
9016 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009017 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009018 ++NumCombined;
9019 }
9020 return 0; // Do not modify these!
9021 }
9022
9023 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
9024 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009025 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009026 ++NumCombined;
9027 return 0;
9028 }
9029
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009030 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
9031 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009032 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009033 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9034 return Res;
9035 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009036 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009037 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9038 return Res;
9039
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009040
9041 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
9042 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009043 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009044 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009045 if (BI->isUnconditional())
9046 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
9047 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009048
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009049 return 0;
9050}
9051
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009052/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
9053/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
9054/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9055///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009056/// Simplify things like:
9057/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
9058/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9059///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009060bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
9061 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
9062
9063 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
9064 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
9065 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009066 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009067
9068 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
9069 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009070 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
9071 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009072 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009073 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009074 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009075 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009076 return false;
9077
9078 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009079 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009080 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009081 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009082 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009083 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009084 return false;
9085
9086
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009087 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
9088 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009089 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009090 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009091 return false;
9092
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009093 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
9094 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
9095 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
9096 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
9097 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
9098 --BBI;
9099 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
9100 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9101 return false;
9102 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009103 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009104 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
9105 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
9106 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
9107 return false;
9108
9109 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009110 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
9111 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009112 for (;; --BBI) {
9113 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
9114 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
9115 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9116 return false;
9117 break;
9118 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009119 // If we find something that may be using the stored value, or if we run
9120 // out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009121 if (isa<LoadInst>(BBI) || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
9122 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
9123 return false;
9124 }
9125
9126 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
9127 // make sure nothing reads the stored value in StoreBB.
9128 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
9129 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
9130 if (isa<LoadInst>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory())
9131 return false;
9132 }
9133 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009134
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009135 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009136 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
9137 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
9138 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
9139 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
9140 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009141 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
9142 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009143 }
9144
9145 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
9146 // insert it.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009147 BBI = DestBB->begin();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009148 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
9149 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
9150 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
9151
9152 // Nuke the old stores.
9153 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9154 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
9155 ++NumCombined;
9156 return true;
9157}
9158
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009159
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009160Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
9161 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00009162 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009163 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
9164 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
9165 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
9166 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
9167 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9168 BI.setCondition(X);
9169 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9170 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
9171 return &BI;
9172 }
9173
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009174 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
9175 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
9176 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9177 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9178 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
9179 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9180 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009181 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009182 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9183 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009184 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9185 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
9186 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9187 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009188 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009189 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009190 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009191 return &BI;
9192 }
9193
9194 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
9195 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
9196 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9197 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9198 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
9199 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
9200 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9201 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009202 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009203 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9204 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009205 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009206 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009207 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9208 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009209 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009210 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009211 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009212 return &BI;
9213 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009214
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009215 return 0;
9216}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009217
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009218Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
9219 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
9220 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
9221 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
9222 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
9223 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
9224 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009225 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009226 AddRHS));
9227 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009228 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009229 return &SI;
9230 }
9231 }
9232 return 0;
9233}
9234
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009235/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
9236/// is to leave as a vector operation.
9237static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
9238 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9239 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009240 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009241 if (isConstant) return true;
9242 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
9243 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
9244 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
9245 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
9246 return false;
9247 return true;
9248 }
9249 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9250 if (!I) return false;
9251
9252 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
9253 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
9254 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
9255 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
9256 return true;
9257 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
9258 return true;
9259 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
9260 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
9261 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9262 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9263 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009264 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
9265 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
9266 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9267 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9268 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009269
9270 return false;
9271}
9272
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00009273/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
9274///
9275/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
9276/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009277static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
9278 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9279 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9280 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
9281 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9282 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
9283
9284 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009285 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009286 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
9287 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
9288 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
9289 else
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009290 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009291 return Result;
9292}
9293
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009294/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
9295/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
9296/// extracted from the vector.
9297static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009298 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
9299 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009300 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
9301 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009302 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9303
9304 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
9305 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9306 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9307 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009308 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009309 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
9310 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9311 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009312 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
9313 return 0;
9314 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009315
9316 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
9317 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009318 if (EltNo == IIElt)
9319 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009320
9321 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
9322 // vector input.
9323 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009324 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009325 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
9326 if (InEl < Width)
9327 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
9328 else if (InEl < Width*2)
9329 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
9330 else
9331 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009332 }
9333
9334 // Otherwise, we don't know.
9335 return 0;
9336}
9337
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009338Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009339
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009340 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009341 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9342 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9343
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009344 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009345 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
9347
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009348 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009349 // If vector val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009350 // with that operand
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009351 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009352 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009353 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
9354 op0 = 0;
9355 break;
9356 }
9357 if (op0)
9358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009359 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009360
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009361 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
9362 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009363 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009364 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
9365 unsigned VectorWidth =
9366 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
9367
9368 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
9369 // crashing the code below.
9370 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
9371 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9372
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009373 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
9374 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
9375 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009376 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009377 uint64_t UndefElts;
9378 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009379 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009380 UndefElts)) {
9381 EI.setOperand(0, V);
9382 return &EI;
9383 }
9384 }
9385
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009386 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009387 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +00009388
9389 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
9390 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
9391 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
9392 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
9393 if (const VectorType *VT =
9394 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
9395 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
9396 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
9397 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
9398 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009399 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009400
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009401 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009402 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9403 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
9404 // profitable to do so
9405 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009406 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
9407 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
9408 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
9409 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
9410 EI.getName()+".lhs");
9411 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
9412 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
9413 EI.getName()+".rhs");
9414 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
9415 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
9416 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
9417 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009418 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009419 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009420 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
9421 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencerde331242006-11-29 01:11:01 +00009422 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009423 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
9424 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009425 }
9426 }
9427 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
9428 // Extracting the inserted element?
9429 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
9430 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
9431 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
9432 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
9433 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
9434 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9435 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
9436 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
9437 return &EI;
9438 }
9439 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
9440 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
9441 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009442 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9443 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009444 Value *Src;
9445 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
9446 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
9447 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
9448 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9449 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
9450 } else {
9451 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00009452 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009453 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009454 }
9455 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009456 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009457 return 0;
9458}
9459
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009460/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
9461/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
9462/// Otherwise, return false.
9463static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
9464 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
9465 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
9466 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009467 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009468
9469 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009470 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009471 return true;
9472 } else if (V == LHS) {
9473 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009474 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009475 return true;
9476 } else if (V == RHS) {
9477 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009478 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009479 return true;
9480 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9481 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9482 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9483 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9484 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9485
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009486 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
9487 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009488 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009489
9490 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
9491 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9492 // transitively ok.
9493 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9494 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009495 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009496 return true;
9497 }
9498 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
9499 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009500 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9501 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009502 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009503
9504 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
9505 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
9506 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9507 // transitively ok.
9508 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9509 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
9510 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
9511 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009512 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009513 } else {
9514 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
9515 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009516 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009517
9518 }
9519 return true;
9520 }
9521 }
9522 }
9523 }
9524 }
9525 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
9526
9527 return false;
9528}
9529
9530/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
9531/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
9532/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009533static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009534 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009535 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009536 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009537 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009538 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009539
9540 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009541 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009542 return V;
9543 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009544 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009545 return V;
9546 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9547 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9548 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9549 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9550 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9551
9552 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9553 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9554 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9555 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009556 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9557 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009558
9559 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
9560 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009561 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
9562 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
9563 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009564 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009565 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009566 return V;
9567 }
9568
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009569 if (VecOp == RHS) {
9570 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009571 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
9572 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
9573 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009574 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009575 }
9576 return V;
9577 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009578
9579 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
9580 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
9581 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
9582 return EI->getOperand(0);
9583
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009584 }
9585 }
9586 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009587 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009588
9589 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
9590 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009591 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009592 return V;
9593}
9594
9595Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
9596 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
9597 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
9598 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
9599
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +00009600 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
9601 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
9602 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9603
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009604 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
9605 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
9606 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9607 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9608 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
9609 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00009610 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
9611 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009612 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009613
9614 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
9615 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9616
9617 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
9618 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
9619
9620 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
9621 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
9622 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
9623 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9624
9625 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
9626 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
9627 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
9628 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
9629 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
9630 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
9631 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
9632 // Build a new shuffle mask.
9633 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
9634 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009635 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009636 else {
9637 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009638 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009639 NumVectorElts));
9640 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009641 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009642 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009643 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009644 }
9645
9646 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
9647 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
9648 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
9649 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009650 Value *RHS = 0;
9651 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
9652 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
9653 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009654 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009655 }
9656 }
9657 }
9658
9659 return 0;
9660}
9661
9662
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009663Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
9664 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9665 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009666 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009667
9668 bool MadeChange = false;
9669
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009670 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009671 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009672 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
9673
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009674 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009675 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009676 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
9677 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
9678 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
9679 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9680 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
9681 Mask[i] = 2*e;
9682 MadeChange = true;
9683 }
9684 }
9685
9686 if (MadeChange) {
9687 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9688 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9689 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9690 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
9691 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
9692 else
9693 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
9694 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009695 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009696 }
9697 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009698
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009699 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
9700 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
9701 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
9702 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009703 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
9704 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9705 }
9706
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009707 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9708 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9709 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009710 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009711 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009712 else {
9713 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
9714 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
9715 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
9716 else
9717 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009718 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009719 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009720 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009721 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009722 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009723 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009724 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9725 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009726 MadeChange = true;
9727 }
9728
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009729 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009730 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009731
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009732 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9733 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
9734 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
9735 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
9736
9737 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
9738 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009739 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009740
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009741 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
9742 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9743 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009744
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009745 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
9746 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
9747 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
9748 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
9749 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
9750 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
9751 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
9752 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
9753 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
9754 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
9755 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
9756 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
9757
9758 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
9759 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
9760 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
9761 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
9762 else
9763 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
9764
9765 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
9766 // the replacement.
9767 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
9768 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9769 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9770 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009771 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009772 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009773 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009774 }
9775 }
9776 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
9777 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009778 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009779 }
9780 }
9781 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00009782
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009783 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
9784}
9785
9786
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009787
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009788
9789/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
9790/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
9791/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
9792/// end of its block.
9793static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
9794 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
9795
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +00009796 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
9797 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009798
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009799 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +00009800 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
9801 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009802 return false;
9803
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009804 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
9805 // the end of block that could change the value.
9806 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009807 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
9808 Scan != E; ++Scan)
9809 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
9810 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009811 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009812
9813 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
9814 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
9815
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +00009816 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009817 ++NumSunkInst;
9818 return true;
9819}
9820
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009821
9822/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
9823/// all reachable code to the worklist.
9824///
9825/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
9826/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
9827/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
9828/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
9829/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
9830///
9831static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009832 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009833 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009834 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009835 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
9836 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009837
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009838 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9839 BB = Worklist.back();
9840 Worklist.pop_back();
9841
9842 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
9843 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
9844
9845 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
9846 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009847
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009848 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
9849 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
9850 ++NumDeadInst;
9851 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
9852 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9853 continue;
9854 }
9855
9856 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
9857 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
9858 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
9859 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
9860 ++NumConstProp;
9861 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9862 continue;
9863 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +00009864
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009865 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009866 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009867
9868 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
9869 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
9870 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
9871 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
9872 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
9873 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
9874 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
9875 continue;
9876 }
9877 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
9878 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
9879 // See if this is an explicit destination.
9880 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9881 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
9882 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
9883 continue;
9884 }
9885
9886 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
9887 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
9888 continue;
9889 }
9890 }
9891
9892 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9893 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009894 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009895}
9896
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009897bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009898 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +00009899 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009900
9901 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
9902 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009903
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009904 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009905 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
9906 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
9907 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009908 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009909 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00009910
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009911 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
9912 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
9913 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
9914 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
9915 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
9916 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
9917 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
9918 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +00009919
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009920 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009921 ++NumDeadInst;
9922
9923 if (!I->use_empty())
9924 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
9925 I->eraseFromParent();
9926 }
9927 }
9928 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009929
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009930 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9931 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
9932 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009933
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009934 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009935 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009936 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009937 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009938 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009939 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009940
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009941 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009942
9943 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009944 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009945 continue;
9946 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009947
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009948 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +00009949 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009950 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009951
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009952 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009953 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +00009954 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
9955
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009956 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009957 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009958 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009959 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009960 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009961
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009962 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
9963 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9964 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
9965 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
9966 if (UserParent != BB) {
9967 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
9968 // See if the user is one of our successors.
9969 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
9970 if (*SI == UserParent) {
9971 UserIsSuccessor = true;
9972 break;
9973 }
9974
9975 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
9976 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
9977 // otherwise), we can keep going.
9978 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
9979 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
9980 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
9981 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
9982 }
9983 }
9984
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009985 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +00009986#ifndef NDEBUG
9987 std::string OrigI;
9988#endif
9989 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009990 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +00009991 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009992 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009993 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009994 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
9995 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009996
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009997 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
9998 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
9999
10000 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010001 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010002 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010003
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010004 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
10005 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010006
10007 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
10008 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010009 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
10010
10011 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
10012 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
10013 ++InsertPos;
10014
10015 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010016
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010017 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
10018 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010019 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000010020
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010021 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
10022 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010023 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010024
10025 // Erase the old instruction.
10026 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010027 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010028#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010029 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
10030 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010031#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010032
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010033 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
10034 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010035 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
10036 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
10037 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010038 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010039
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010040 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010041 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010042 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010043 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010044 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010045 AddToWorkList(I);
10046 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010047 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010048 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010049 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010050 }
10051 }
10052
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010053 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010054 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010055}
10056
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010057
10058bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010059 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
10060
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010061 bool EverMadeChange = false;
10062
10063 // Iterate while there is work to do.
10064 unsigned Iteration = 0;
10065 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
10066 EverMadeChange = true;
10067 return EverMadeChange;
10068}
10069
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000010070FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010071 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010072}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000010073